Switch license to GPLv3 or later.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
186
187 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
188
189 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
190 use. */
191
192 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
193
194 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
195 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
196 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
197 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
198
199 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
200
201 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
202 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
203 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
204 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
205
206 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
207
208 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
209
210 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
211
212 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
213 /* The application context for Xt use. */
214 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
215 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
216 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
217
218 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
219
220 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
221
222 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
223 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
224
225 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
226
227 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
228 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
229 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
230
231 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
232
233 /* Mouse movement.
234
235 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
236 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
237 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
238 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
239
240 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
241
242 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
243 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
244 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
245 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
246 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
247 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
248 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
249 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
250 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
251 is off. */
252
253 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
254
255 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
256 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
257 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
258
259 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
260
261 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
262 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
263 an ordinary motion.
264
265 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
266 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
267 event. */
268
269 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
270
271 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
272 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
273 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
274 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
275 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
276 it's somewhat accurate. */
277
278 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
279
280 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
281
282 static Time last_user_time;
283
284 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
285 events. */
286
287 #ifdef __STDC__
288 static int volatile input_signal_count;
289 #else
290 static int input_signal_count;
291 #endif
292
293 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
294
295 static int x_noop_count;
296
297 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
298
299 extern char **initial_argv;
300 extern int initial_argc;
301
302 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
303
304 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
305
306 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
307
308 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
309
310 extern int errno;
311
312 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
313
314 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
315
316 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
317
318 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
319 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
320 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
321
322 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
323 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
324
325 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
326 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
327
328 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
329 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
330 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
331 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
332
333 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
334 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
335 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
336 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
339 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
340 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
341 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
344 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
345 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
346 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
347 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
348 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
350 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
351 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
352 enum text_cursor_kinds));
353
354 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
355 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
356 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
357 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
358 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
359 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
360 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
361 enum scroll_bar_part *,
362 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
363 unsigned long *));
364 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
365 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
366 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
367 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
368 int *, struct input_event *));
369 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
370 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
371 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
372
373
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
375
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
379 {
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
382 {
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
386 }
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 }
391
392
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
399
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
401
402 \f
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
406
407 #if 0
408
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
411
412 struct record
413 {
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 };
417
418 struct record event_record[100];
419
420 int event_record_index;
421
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
425 {
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
428
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
432 }
433
434 #endif /* 0 */
435
436
437 \f
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
439
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
443 {
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
445
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
449
450 return 0;
451 }
452
453
454 \f
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
458
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
464
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
468 {
469 /* Nothing to do. */
470 }
471
472
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
476
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
480 {
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
483
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
486
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
490 {
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
493
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
498
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
505
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
513 {
514 int i;
515
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
519
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
522 }
523 #endif /* 0 */
524 }
525
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
531
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
536 {
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
539
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
544
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
547 }
548
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
550
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
553
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
557
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
566 {
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
568
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
570 {
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
572
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
577
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
580
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
582 }
583
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
587 {
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
591 }
592
593 updated_window = NULL;
594 }
595
596
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
599
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
603 {
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
606
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
612 }
613
614
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
618
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
622 {
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
624 {
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
626
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
629 {
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
637 }
638 }
639 }
640
641
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
648
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
652 {
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
656
657 xassert (w);
658
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
661
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
675 {
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
677
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
682
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
690 }
691 }
692
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
705
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
709 {
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
719 }
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
722
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
724 {
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
733
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
736
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
739 }
740
741 if (p->which)
742 {
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
747
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
752
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
761
762 if (p->overlay_p)
763 {
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
772 }
773
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
777
778 if (p->overlay_p)
779 {
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
783 }
784 }
785
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 }
788
789 \f
790
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
795
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
798 {
799 }
800
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
803
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
806 {
807 }
808
809
810 \f
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
814
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
816
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
818
819
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
822
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
828 {
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
831
832 xassert (font && char2b);
833
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
835 {
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
837 {
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
848 }
849 else
850 {
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
855
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
858
859 where:
860
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
868 {
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
873 }
874 }
875 }
876 else
877 {
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
884 }
885
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
889 }
890
891
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
894
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
901 {
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
904
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
909 {
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
912
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
915 {
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
925 }
926
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
928
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
935 }
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
937 {
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
941
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
945
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
948 }
949
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
952
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
954 }
955
956
957 \f
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
961
962
963
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
992
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
996
997
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1000
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1004 {
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1011 {
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1015
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1018
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1030 {
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1033 }
1034
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049 }
1050
1051
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 {
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1060
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1066
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1073
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1078 {
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1083
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1090
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1097
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1099 }
1100
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1102 }
1103
1104
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1108
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1120
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1124 {
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1126
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1133 {
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1138 {
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1143 {
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1146 }
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1161 }
1162
1163
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1166
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1170 {
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1174 }
1175
1176
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1184 {
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1187 {
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1194 }
1195 }
1196
1197
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1199
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1204 {
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1210 }
1211
1212
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1218
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1223 {
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1227 {
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1229
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1231 {
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1240 }
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1245 {
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1260 {
1261 int i, x;
1262
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1270
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1274 {
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1276 {
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1282 }
1283 }
1284 else
1285 {
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1288
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1291
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1296
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1304 {
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1312 }
1313 else
1314 {
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 }
1322
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 {
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1333 }
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1338
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1342 {
1343 int i, x;
1344
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1352
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1357
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1361 {
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1369 {
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 }
1380 }
1381 }
1382
1383
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1385
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1391
1392
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1395
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1399 {
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1403
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1405
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1412
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1422
1423 abort ();
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1431
1432 int
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1437 {
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1440 }
1441
1442
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1449
1450 int
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1458 {
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1461 }
1462
1463
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1466
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1468 {
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1473 };
1474
1475
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1478
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1480
1481
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1483
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1485
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1490
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1493
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1496
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1498
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1506 {
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1512
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1514 {
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1520 }
1521
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1525
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1532 {
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 }
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1538 {
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1541 }
1542 else
1543 {
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1546
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1556 {
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1558 {
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1564 }
1565 else
1566 {
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1569 }
1570
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1573 }
1574
1575
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1579
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1581
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1585
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1626 {
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1628
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1630 {
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1633
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1642
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1645 }
1646
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 }
1650
1651
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1654
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1660 {
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 {
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 {
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 }
1673 }
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 }
1677
1678
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1774 {
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1777 }
1778
1779
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1783
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1806
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1812 {
1813 XColor color;
1814
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1824 }
1825
1826
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1829
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1835
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1839
1840
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1856 {
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1860
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1864
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1870
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1873
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1879 {
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1884
1885 if (factor < 1)
1886 {
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1890 }
1891 else
1892 {
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1896 }
1897 }
1898
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1902 {
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1904 {
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1908
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1913 }
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 return success_p;
1920 }
1921
1922
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1937 {
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1946
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1949
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1955 {
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1965 {
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1968 }
1969
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1971 {
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1975 }
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2032 {
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2037
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2043
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2076
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2078 }
2079
2080
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2087
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2094 {
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2096
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2100
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2113
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2118
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2121 }
2122
2123
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2125
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 {
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2134
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2138
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2143
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2152
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2161
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2163
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2168 {
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2172 }
2173 }
2174
2175
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2177
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2272 {
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2326 {
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2329
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2336
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2343
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2345 {
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2347 {
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2356
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2362
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2373
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2381 {
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2387 }
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2394 }
2395
2396
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2399
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2404 {
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2406 {
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2418
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2422 |
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2425 | |
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2428
2429 */
2430
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2434 {
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2439
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2445
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2456 {
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2458 {
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2464
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2469
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2473
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2476 {
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2482 }
2483 else
2484 {
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2498
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2502
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2505
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2507 }
2508
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2510 }
2511
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2514 {
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2523
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2533
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2537 {
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2540
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2543 {
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2547 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2548
2549 if (x < left_x)
2550 {
2551 background_width -= left_x - x;
2552 x = left_x;
2553 }
2554 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2555
2556 /* Draw cursor. */
2557 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2558
2559 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2560 if (width < background_width)
2561 {
2562 int y = s->y;
2563 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2564 XRectangle r;
2565 GC gc;
2566
2567 x += width;
2568 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2569 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2570 {
2571 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2572 gc = s->gc;
2573 }
2574 else
2575 gc = s->face->gc;
2576
2577 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2578 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2579
2580 if (s->face->stipple)
2581 {
2582 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2583 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2586 }
2587 else
2588 {
2589 XGCValues xgcv;
2590 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2591 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2592 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2593 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2594 }
2595 }
2596 }
2597 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2598 {
2599 int background_width = s->background_width;
2600 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2601
2602 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2603 except for header line and mode line. */
2604 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2605 {
2606 background_width -= left_x - x;
2607 x = left_x;
2608 }
2609 if (background_width > 0)
2610 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2611 }
2612
2613 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2614 }
2615
2616
2617 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2618
2619 static void
2620 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2621 struct glyph_string *s;
2622 {
2623 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2624
2625 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2626 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2627 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2628 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2629 {
2630 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2631 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2632 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2633 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2634 }
2635
2636 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2637 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2638
2639 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2640 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2641 if (!s->for_overlaps
2642 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2643 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2644 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2645
2646 {
2647 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2648 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2650 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2651 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2652 }
2653 else
2654 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2655
2656 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2657 {
2658 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2659 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2660 break;
2661
2662 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2663 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2664 break;
2665
2666 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2667 if (s->for_overlaps)
2668 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2669 else
2670 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2671 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2672 break;
2673
2674 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2675 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2676 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2677 else
2678 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2679 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2680 break;
2681
2682 default:
2683 abort ();
2684 }
2685
2686 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2687 {
2688 /* Draw underline. */
2689 if (s->face->underline_p)
2690 {
2691 unsigned long tem, h;
2692 int y;
2693
2694 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2695 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2696 h = 1;
2697
2698 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2699 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2700 {
2701 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2702 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2703 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2704 specs, and its default is
2705
2706 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2707 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2708
2709 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2710 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2711 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2712 else if (s->face->font)
2713 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2714 }
2715
2716 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2717 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2718 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2719 else
2720 {
2721 XGCValues xgcv;
2722 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2724 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2725 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2726 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2727 }
2728 }
2729
2730 /* Draw overline. */
2731 if (s->face->overline_p)
2732 {
2733 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2734
2735 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2736 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2737 s->background_width, h);
2738 else
2739 {
2740 XGCValues xgcv;
2741 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2743 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2744 s->background_width, h);
2745 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2746 }
2747 }
2748
2749 /* Draw strike-through. */
2750 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2751 {
2752 unsigned long h = 1;
2753 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2754
2755 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2756 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2757 s->width, h);
2758 else
2759 {
2760 XGCValues xgcv;
2761 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2762 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2763 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2764 s->width, h);
2765 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2766 }
2767 }
2768
2769 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2770 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2771 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Reset clipping. */
2775 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2776 }
2777
2778 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2779
2780 void
2781 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2782 struct frame *f;
2783 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2784 {
2785 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2786 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2787 x, y, width, height,
2788 x + shift_by, y);
2789 }
2790
2791 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2792 for X frames. */
2793
2794 static void
2795 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2796 register int n;
2797 {
2798 abort ();
2799 }
2800
2801
2802 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2803 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2804
2805 void
2806 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2807 Display *dpy;
2808 Window window;
2809 int x, y;
2810 int width, height;
2811 int exposures;
2812 {
2813 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2814 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2815 }
2816
2817
2818 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2819 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2820
2821 static void
2822 x_clear_frame ()
2823 {
2824 struct frame *f;
2825
2826 if (updating_frame)
2827 f = updating_frame;
2828 else
2829 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2830
2831 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2832 longer visible. */
2833 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2834 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2835 output_cursor.x = -1;
2836
2837 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2838 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2839 BLOCK_INPUT;
2840 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2841
2842 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2843 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2844 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2845
2846 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2847
2848 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2849 }
2850
2851
2852 \f
2853 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2854
2855 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2856 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2857
2858 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2859
2860
2861 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2862 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2863
2864 static int
2865 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2866 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2867 {
2868 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2869 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2870 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2871 {
2872 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2873 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2874 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2875 }
2876
2877 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2878 {
2879 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2880 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2881 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2882 }
2883
2884 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2885 positive. */
2886 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2887 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2888
2889 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2890 negative. */
2891 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2892 }
2893
2894 void
2895 XTflash (f)
2896 struct frame *f;
2897 {
2898 BLOCK_INPUT;
2899
2900 {
2901 GC gc;
2902
2903 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2904 pixels into background pixels. */
2905 {
2906 XGCValues values;
2907
2908 values.function = GXxor;
2909 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2910 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2911
2912 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2913 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2914 }
2915
2916 {
2917 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2918 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2919 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2920 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2921 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2922 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2923 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2924
2925 int width;
2926
2927 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2928 edge it is next to. */
2929 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2930 {
2931 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2932 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2933 break;
2934
2935 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2936 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2937 break;
2938
2939 default:
2940 break;
2941 }
2942
2943 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2944
2945 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2946 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2947 {
2948 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2949 flash_left,
2950 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2951 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2952 width, flash_height);
2953 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2954 flash_left,
2955 (height - flash_height
2956 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2957 width, flash_height);
2958 }
2959 else
2960 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2961 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2962 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2963 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2964
2965 x_flush (f);
2966
2967 {
2968 struct timeval wakeup;
2969
2970 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2971
2972 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2973 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2974 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2975 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2976
2977 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2978 available. */
2979 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2980 {
2981 struct timeval current;
2982 struct timeval timeout;
2983
2984 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2985
2986 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2987 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2988 break;
2989
2990 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2991 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2992 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2993
2994 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2995 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2996 }
2997 }
2998
2999 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3000 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3001 {
3002 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3003 flash_left,
3004 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3005 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3006 width, flash_height);
3007 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3008 flash_left,
3009 (height - flash_height
3010 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3011 width, flash_height);
3012 }
3013 else
3014 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3015 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3016 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3017 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3018
3019 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3020 x_flush (f);
3021 }
3022 }
3023
3024 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3025 }
3026
3027 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3028
3029
3030 /* Make audible bell. */
3031
3032 void
3033 XTring_bell ()
3034 {
3035 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3036
3037 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3038 {
3039 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3040 if (visible_bell)
3041 XTflash (f);
3042 else
3043 #endif
3044 {
3045 BLOCK_INPUT;
3046 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3047 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3048 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3049 }
3050 }
3051 }
3052
3053 \f
3054 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3055 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3056 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3057 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3058
3059 static void
3060 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3061 register int n;
3062 {
3063 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3064 }
3065
3066
3067 \f
3068 /***********************************************************************
3069 Line Dance
3070 ***********************************************************************/
3071
3072 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3073 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3074
3075 static void
3076 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3077 int vpos, n;
3078 {
3079 abort ();
3080 }
3081
3082
3083 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3084
3085 static void
3086 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3087 struct window *w;
3088 struct run *run;
3089 {
3090 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3091 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3092
3093 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3094 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3095 fringe of W. */
3096 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3097
3098 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3099 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3100 bottom_y = y + height;
3101
3102 if (to_y < from_y)
3103 {
3104 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3105 line at the bottom. */
3106 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3107 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3108 else
3109 height = run->height;
3110 }
3111 else
3112 {
3113 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3114 at the bottom. */
3115 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3116 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3117 else
3118 height = run->height;
3119 }
3120
3121 BLOCK_INPUT;
3122
3123 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3124 updated_window = w;
3125 x_clear_cursor (w);
3126
3127 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3128 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3129 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3130 x, from_y,
3131 width, height,
3132 x, to_y);
3133
3134 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3135 }
3136
3137
3138 \f
3139 /***********************************************************************
3140 Exposure Events
3141 ***********************************************************************/
3142
3143 \f
3144 static void
3145 frame_highlight (f)
3146 struct frame *f;
3147 {
3148 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3149 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3150 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3151 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3152 BLOCK_INPUT;
3153 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3154 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3155 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3156 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3157 }
3158
3159 static void
3160 frame_unhighlight (f)
3161 struct frame *f;
3162 {
3163 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3164 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3165 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3166 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3167 BLOCK_INPUT;
3168 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3169 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3170 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3171 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3172 }
3173
3174 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3175 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3176 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3177 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3178 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3179
3180 static void
3181 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3182 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3183 struct frame *frame;
3184 {
3185 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3186
3187 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3188 {
3189 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3190 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3191 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3192
3193 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3194 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3195
3196 #if 0
3197 selected_frame = frame;
3198 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3199 selected_frame);
3200 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3201 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3202 #endif /* ! 0 */
3203
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3205 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3206 else
3207 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3208 }
3209
3210 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3211 }
3212
3213 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3214 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3215 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3216
3217 static void
3218 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3219 int type;
3220 int state;
3221 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3222 struct frame *frame;
3223 struct input_event *bufp;
3224 {
3225 if (type == FocusIn)
3226 {
3227 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3228 {
3229 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3230 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3231
3232 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3233 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3234 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3235 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3236 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3237 {
3238 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3239 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3240 }
3241 }
3242
3243 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3244
3245 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3246 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3247 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3248 #endif
3249 }
3250 else if (type == FocusOut)
3251 {
3252 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3253
3254 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3255 {
3256 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3257 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3258 }
3259
3260 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3261 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3262 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3263 #endif
3264 }
3265 }
3266
3267 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3268 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3269
3270 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3271
3272 static void
3273 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3275 XEvent *event;
3276 struct input_event *bufp;
3277 {
3278 struct frame *frame;
3279
3280 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3281 if (! frame)
3282 return;
3283
3284 switch (event->type)
3285 {
3286 case EnterNotify:
3287 case LeaveNotify:
3288 {
3289 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3290 int focus_state
3291 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3292
3293 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3294 && event->xcrossing.focus
3295 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3296 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3297 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3298 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3299 }
3300 break;
3301
3302 case FocusIn:
3303 case FocusOut:
3304 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3305 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3306 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3307 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3308 break;
3309 }
3310 }
3311
3312
3313 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3314
3315 void
3316 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 {
3319 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3320 }
3321
3322 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3323 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3324 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3325
3326 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3327 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3328 the appropriate X display info. */
3329
3330 static void
3331 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3332 struct frame *frame;
3333 {
3334 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3335 }
3336
3337 static void
3338 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3340 {
3341 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3342
3343 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3344 {
3345 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3346 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3347 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3348 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3349 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3350 {
3351 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3352 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3353 }
3354 }
3355 else
3356 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3357
3358 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3359 {
3360 if (old_highlight)
3361 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3362 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3363 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3364 }
3365 }
3366
3367
3368 \f
3369 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3370
3371 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3372 static void
3373 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3374 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3375 {
3376 int min_code, max_code;
3377 KeySym *syms;
3378 int syms_per_code;
3379 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3380
3381 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3382 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3383 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3384 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3385 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3386
3387 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3388 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3389 #else
3390 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3391 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3392 #endif
3393
3394 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3395 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3396 &syms_per_code);
3397 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3398
3399 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3400 Alt keysyms are on. */
3401 {
3402 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3403 int found_alt_or_meta;
3404
3405 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3406 {
3407 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3408 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3409 {
3410 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3411
3412 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3413 if (code == 0)
3414 continue;
3415
3416 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3417 {
3418 int code_col;
3419
3420 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3421 {
3422 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3423
3424 switch (sym)
3425 {
3426 case XK_Meta_L:
3427 case XK_Meta_R:
3428 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3429 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3430 break;
3431
3432 case XK_Alt_L:
3433 case XK_Alt_R:
3434 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3435 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3436 break;
3437
3438 case XK_Hyper_L:
3439 case XK_Hyper_R:
3440 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3441 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3442 code_col = syms_per_code;
3443 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3444 break;
3445
3446 case XK_Super_L:
3447 case XK_Super_R:
3448 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3449 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3450 code_col = syms_per_code;
3451 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3452 break;
3453
3454 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3455 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3456 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3457 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3458 code_col = syms_per_code;
3459 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3460 break;
3461 }
3462 }
3463 }
3464 }
3465 }
3466 }
3467
3468 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3469 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3470 {
3471 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3472 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3473 }
3474
3475 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3476 make them just meta, not alt. */
3477 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3478 {
3479 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3480 }
3481
3482 XFree ((char *) syms);
3483 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3484 }
3485
3486 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3487 Emacs uses. */
3488
3489 unsigned int
3490 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3491 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3492 unsigned int state;
3493 {
3494 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3495 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3496 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3497 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3498 Lisp_Object tem;
3499
3500 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3501 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3502 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3503 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3504 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3505 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3506 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3507 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3508
3509
3510 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3511 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3512 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3513 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3514 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3515 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3516 }
3517
3518 static unsigned int
3519 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3520 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3521 unsigned int state;
3522 {
3523 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3524 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3525 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3526 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3527
3528 Lisp_Object tem;
3529
3530 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3531 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3532 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3533 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3534 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3535 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3536 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3537 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3538
3539
3540 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3541 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3542 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3543 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3544 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3545 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3546 }
3547
3548 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3549
3550 char *
3551 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3552 KeySym keysym;
3553 {
3554 char *value;
3555
3556 BLOCK_INPUT;
3557 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3559
3560 return value;
3561 }
3562
3563
3564 \f
3565 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3566
3567 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3568
3569 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3570 the mouse. */
3571
3572 static Lisp_Object
3573 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3574 struct input_event *result;
3575 XButtonEvent *event;
3576 struct frame *f;
3577 {
3578 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3579 otherwise. */
3580 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3581 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3582 result->timestamp = event->time;
3583 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3584 event->state)
3585 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3586 ? up_modifier
3587 : down_modifier));
3588
3589 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3590 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3591 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3592 result->arg = Qnil;
3593 return Qnil;
3594 }
3595
3596 \f
3597 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3598 The input handler calls this.
3599
3600 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3601 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3602 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3603 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3604
3605 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3606 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3607
3608 static int
3609 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3610 FRAME_PTR frame;
3611 XMotionEvent *event;
3612 {
3613 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3614 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3615 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3616
3617 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3618 return 0;
3619
3620 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3621 {
3622 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3623 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3624 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3625 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3626 return 1;
3627 }
3628
3629
3630 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3631 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3632 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3633 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3634 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3635 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3636 {
3637 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3638 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3639 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3640 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3641 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3642 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3643 return 1;
3644 }
3645
3646 return 0;
3647 }
3648
3649 \f
3650 /************************************************************************
3651 Mouse Face
3652 ************************************************************************/
3653
3654 static void
3655 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3656 {
3657 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3658 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3659 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3660 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3661 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3662 }
3663
3664
3665
3666 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3667 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3668
3669 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3670 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3671 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3672 position on the scroll bar.
3673
3674 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3675 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3676 the mouse is over.
3677
3678 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3679 was at this position.
3680
3681 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3682
3683 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3684 movement. */
3685
3686 static void
3687 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3688 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3689 int insist;
3690 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3691 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3692 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3693 unsigned long *time;
3694 {
3695 FRAME_PTR f1;
3696
3697 BLOCK_INPUT;
3698
3699 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3700 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3701 else
3702 {
3703 Window root;
3704 int root_x, root_y;
3705
3706 Window dummy_window;
3707 int dummy;
3708
3709 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3710
3711 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3712 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3713 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3714 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3715
3716 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3717
3718 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3719 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3720 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3721
3722 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3723 &root,
3724
3725 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3726 a different screen. */
3727 &dummy_window,
3728
3729 /* The position on that root window. */
3730 &root_x, &root_y,
3731
3732 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3733 &dummy, &dummy,
3734
3735 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3736 we don't care. */
3737 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3738
3739 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3740 containing the pointer. */
3741 {
3742 Window win, child;
3743 int win_x, win_y;
3744 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3745
3746 win = root;
3747
3748 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3749 structure is changing at the same time this function
3750 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3751
3752 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3753
3754 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3755 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3756 {
3757 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3758 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3759 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3760
3761 /* From-window, to-window. */
3762 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3763
3764 /* From-position, to-position. */
3765 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3766
3767 /* Child of win. */
3768 &child);
3769 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3770 }
3771 else
3772 {
3773 while (1)
3774 {
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3776
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, win,
3779
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3782
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3785
3786 if (child == None || child == win)
3787 break;
3788
3789 win = child;
3790 parent_x = win_x;
3791 parent_y = win_y;
3792 }
3793
3794 /* Now we know that:
3795 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3796 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3797 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3798 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3799 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3800 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3801 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3802 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3803 never use them in that case.) */
3804
3805 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3806 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3807
3808 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3809 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3810 on the frame. */
3811 if (f1 != NULL
3812 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3813 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3814 f1 = NULL;
3815 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3816 }
3817
3818 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3819 f1 = 0;
3820
3821 x_uncatch_errors ();
3822
3823 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3824 if (! f1)
3825 {
3826 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3827
3828 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3829
3830 if (bar)
3831 {
3832 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3833 win_x = parent_x;
3834 win_y = parent_y;
3835 }
3836 }
3837
3838 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3839 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3840
3841 if (f1)
3842 {
3843 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3844 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3845 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3846 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3847 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3848 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3849 the frame are divided into. */
3850
3851 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3852 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3853
3854 *bar_window = Qnil;
3855 *part = 0;
3856 *fp = f1;
3857 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3858 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3859 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3860 }
3861 }
3862 }
3863
3864 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3865 }
3866
3867
3868 \f
3869 /***********************************************************************
3870 Scroll bars
3871 ***********************************************************************/
3872
3873 /* Scroll bar support. */
3874
3875 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3876 manages it.
3877 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3878 bits. */
3879
3880 static struct scroll_bar *
3881 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3882 Display *display;
3883 Window window_id;
3884 {
3885 Lisp_Object tail;
3886
3887 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3888 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3889 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3890
3891 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3892 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3893 tail = XCDR (tail))
3894 {
3895 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3896
3897 frame = XCAR (tail);
3898 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3899 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3900 abort ();
3901
3902 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3903 right window ID. */
3904 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3905 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3906 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3907 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3908 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3909 condemned = Qnil,
3910 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3911 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3912 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3913 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3914 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3915 }
3916
3917 return 0;
3918 }
3919
3920
3921 #if defined USE_LUCID
3922
3923 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3924 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3925
3926 static Widget
3927 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3928 Window window;
3929 {
3930 Lisp_Object tail;
3931
3932 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3933 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3934 tail = XCDR (tail))
3935 {
3936 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3937 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3938
3939 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3940 return menu_bar;
3941 }
3942
3943 return NULL;
3944 }
3945
3946 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3947
3948 \f
3949 /************************************************************************
3950 Toolkit scroll bars
3951 ************************************************************************/
3952
3953 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3954
3955 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3956 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3957 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3958 struct scroll_bar *));
3959 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3960 int, int, int));
3961
3962
3963 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3964 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3965
3966 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3967
3968 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3969
3970 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3971
3972 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3973 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3974
3975 #ifndef USE_GTK
3976 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3977
3978 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3979
3980 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3981
3982 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3983 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3984 to avoid jerkyness. */
3985
3986 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3987
3988 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3989 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3990 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3991 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3992
3993 static void
3994 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3995 num_params)
3996 Widget widget;
3997 XtPointer client_data;
3998 String action_name;
3999 XEvent *event;
4000 String *params;
4001 Cardinal *num_params;
4002 {
4003 int scroll_bar_p;
4004 char *end_action;
4005
4006 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4007 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4008 end_action = "Release";
4009 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4010 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4011 end_action = "EndScroll";
4012 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4013
4014 if (scroll_bar_p
4015 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4016 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4017 {
4018 struct window *w;
4019
4020 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4021 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4022 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4023
4024 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4025 {
4026 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4027 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4028 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4029 }
4030 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4031 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4032
4033 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4034 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4035 }
4036 }
4037 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4038
4039 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4040 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4041
4042 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4043 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4044
4045
4046 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4047 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4048 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4049 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4050
4051 static void
4052 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4053 Lisp_Object window;
4054 int part, portion, whole;
4055 {
4056 XEvent event;
4057 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4058 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4059 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4060 int i;
4061
4062 BLOCK_INPUT;
4063
4064 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4065 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4066 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4067 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4068 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4069 ev->format = 32;
4070
4071 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4072 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4073 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4074 into that array in the event. */
4075 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4076 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4077 break;
4078
4079 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4080 {
4081 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4082 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4083 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4084
4085 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4086 nbytes);
4087 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4088 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4089 }
4090
4091 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4092 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4093 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4094 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4095 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4096 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4097
4098 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4099 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4100 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4101 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4102 #endif
4103
4104 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4105 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4106 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4107 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4108 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4109 }
4110
4111
4112 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4113 in *IEVENT. */
4114
4115 static void
4116 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4117 XEvent *event;
4118 struct input_event *ievent;
4119 {
4120 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4121 Lisp_Object window;
4122 struct frame *f;
4123 struct window *w;
4124
4125 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4126 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4127
4128 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4129 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4130
4131 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4132 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4133 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4134 #ifdef USE_GTK
4135 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4136 #else
4137 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4138 #endif
4139 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4140 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4141 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4142 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4143 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4144 }
4145
4146
4147 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4148
4149 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4150
4151 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4152
4153
4154 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4155 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4156 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4157
4158 static void
4159 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4160 Widget widget;
4161 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4162 {
4163 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4164 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4165 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4166
4167 switch (cs->reason)
4168 {
4169 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4170 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4171 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4172 break;
4173
4174 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4175 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4176 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4177 break;
4178
4179 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4180 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4181 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4182 break;
4183
4184 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4185 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4186 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4187 break;
4188
4189 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4190 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4191 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4192 break;
4193
4194 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4195 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4196 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4197 break;
4198
4199 case XmCR_DRAG:
4200 {
4201 int slider_size;
4202
4203 /* Get the slider size. */
4204 BLOCK_INPUT;
4205 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4206 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4207
4208 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4209 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4210 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4211 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4212 }
4213 break;
4214
4215 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4216 break;
4217 };
4218
4219 if (part >= 0)
4220 {
4221 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4222 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4223 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4224 }
4225 }
4226
4227
4228 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4229 #ifdef USE_GTK
4230 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4231 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4232
4233 static void
4234 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4235 GtkRange *widget;
4236 gpointer data;
4237 {
4238 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4239 gdouble previous;
4240 gdouble position;
4241 gdouble *p;
4242 int diff;
4243
4244 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4245 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4246
4247 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4248
4249 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4250 if (! p)
4251 {
4252 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4253 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4254 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4255 }
4256
4257 previous = *p;
4258 *p = position;
4259
4260 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4261
4262 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4263
4264 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4265 {
4266 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4267 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4268 }
4269 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4270 {
4271 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4272 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4273 }
4274 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4275 {
4276 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4277 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4278 }
4279 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4280 {
4281 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4282 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4283 }
4284 else
4285 {
4286 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4287 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4288 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4289 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4290 }
4291
4292 if (part >= 0)
4293 {
4294 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4295 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4296 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4297 }
4298 }
4299
4300 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4301
4302 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4303 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4304 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4305 the thumb is. */
4306
4307 static void
4308 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4309 Widget widget;
4310 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4311 {
4312 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4313 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4314 float shown;
4315 int whole, portion, height;
4316 int part;
4317
4318 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4319 BLOCK_INPUT;
4320 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4322
4323 whole = 10000000;
4324 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4325
4326 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4327 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4328 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4329 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4330 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4331 bottom). */
4332 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4333 else
4334 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4335
4336 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4337 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4338 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4339 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4340 }
4341
4342
4343 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4344 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4345 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4346 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4347 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4348 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4349 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4350
4351 static void
4352 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4353 Widget widget;
4354 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4355 {
4356 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4357 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4358 int position = (long) call_data;
4359 Dimension height;
4360 int part;
4361
4362 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4363 BLOCK_INPUT;
4364 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4366
4367 if (abs (position) >= height)
4368 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4369
4370 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4371 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4372 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4373 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4374 else
4375 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4376
4377 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4378 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4379 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4380 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4381 }
4382
4383 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4384 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4385
4386 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4387
4388 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4389 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4390
4391 #ifdef USE_GTK
4392 static void
4393 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4394 struct frame *f;
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4396 {
4397 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4398
4399 BLOCK_INPUT;
4400 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4401 scroll_bar_name);
4402 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4403 }
4404
4405 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4406
4407 static void
4408 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4409 struct frame *f;
4410 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4411 {
4412 Window xwindow;
4413 Widget widget;
4414 Arg av[20];
4415 int ac = 0;
4416 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4417 unsigned long pixel;
4418
4419 BLOCK_INPUT;
4420
4421 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4422 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4425 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4426 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4427 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4429 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4430
4431 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4432 if (pixel != -1)
4433 {
4434 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4435 ++ac;
4436 }
4437
4438 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4439 if (pixel != -1)
4440 {
4441 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4442 ++ac;
4443 }
4444
4445 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4446 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4447
4448 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4449 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4450 (XtPointer) bar);
4451 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4452 (XtPointer) bar);
4453 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4454 (XtPointer) bar);
4455 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4456 (XtPointer) bar);
4457 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4458 (XtPointer) bar);
4459 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4460 (XtPointer) bar);
4461 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4462 (XtPointer) bar);
4463
4464 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4465 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4466
4467 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4468 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4469 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4470 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4471
4472 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4473
4474 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4475 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4476 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4477 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4478 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4479 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4480 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4481 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4482
4483 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4484 if (pixel != -1)
4485 {
4486 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4487 ++ac;
4488 }
4489
4490 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4491 if (pixel != -1)
4492 {
4493 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4494 ++ac;
4495 }
4496
4497 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4498
4499 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4500 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4501 {
4502 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4503 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4504 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4505 pixel = -1;
4506 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4507 }
4508 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4509 {
4510 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4511 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4512 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4513 pixel = -1;
4514 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4515 }
4516
4517 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4518 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4519 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4520 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4521 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4522 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4523 {
4524 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4525 ++ac;
4526 }
4527 else
4528 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4529 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4530 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4531 {
4532 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4533 the shadows. */
4534 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4535 ++ac;
4536
4537 /* Specify the colors. */
4538 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4539 if (pixel != -1)
4540 {
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4542 ++ac;
4543 }
4544 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4545 if (pixel != -1)
4546 {
4547 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4548 ++ac;
4549 }
4550 }
4551 #endif
4552
4553 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4554 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4555
4556 {
4557 char *initial = "";
4558 char *val = initial;
4559 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4560 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4561 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4562 #endif
4563 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4564 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4565 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4566 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4567 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4568 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4569 }
4570 }
4571
4572 /* Define callbacks. */
4573 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4574 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4575 (XtPointer) bar);
4576
4577 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4578 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4579
4580 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4581
4582 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4583 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4584 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4585 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4586
4587 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4588 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4589 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4590 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4591
4592 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4593 }
4594 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4595
4596
4597 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4598 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4599
4600 #ifdef USE_GTK
4601 static void
4602 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4603 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4604 int portion, position, whole;
4605 {
4606 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4607 }
4608
4609 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4610 static void
4611 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4612 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4613 int portion, position, whole;
4614 {
4615 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4616 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4617 float top, shown;
4618
4619 BLOCK_INPUT;
4620
4621 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4622
4623 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4624 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4625 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4626 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4627 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4628 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4629 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4630 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4631 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4632 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4633 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4634 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4635 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4636 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4637 whole += portion;
4638
4639 if (whole <= 0)
4640 top = 0, shown = 1;
4641 else
4642 {
4643 top = (float) position / whole;
4644 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4645 }
4646
4647 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4648 {
4649 int size, value;
4650
4651 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4652 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4653 value. */
4654 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4655 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4656 size = max (size, 1);
4657
4658 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4659 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4660 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4661
4662 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4663 }
4664 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4665
4666 if (whole == 0)
4667 top = 0, shown = 1;
4668 else
4669 {
4670 top = (float) position / whole;
4671 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4672 }
4673
4674 {
4675 float old_top, old_shown;
4676 Dimension height;
4677 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4678 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4679 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4680 XtNheight, &height,
4681 NULL);
4682
4683 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4684 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4685 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4686 else
4687 top = old_top;
4688 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4689 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4690
4691 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4692 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4693 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4694 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4695 {
4696 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4697 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4698 else
4699 {
4700 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4701 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4702 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4703
4704 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4705 }
4706 }
4707 }
4708 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4709
4710 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4711 }
4712 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4713
4714 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715
4716
4717 \f
4718 /************************************************************************
4719 Scroll bars, general
4720 ************************************************************************/
4721
4722 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4723 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4724 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4725 scroll bar. */
4726
4727 static struct scroll_bar *
4728 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4729 struct window *w;
4730 int top, left, width, height;
4731 {
4732 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4733 struct scroll_bar *bar
4734 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4735
4736 BLOCK_INPUT;
4737
4738 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4739 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4740 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4741 {
4742 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4743 unsigned long mask;
4744 Window window;
4745
4746 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4747 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4748 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4749
4750 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4751 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4752 | ExposureMask);
4753 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4754
4755 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4756
4757 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4758 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4759 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4760 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4761 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4762 left, top, width,
4763 window_box_height (w), False);
4764
4765 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4766 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4767 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4768 top,
4769 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4770 height,
4771 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4772 0,
4773 CopyFromParent,
4774 CopyFromParent,
4775 CopyFromParent,
4776 /* Attributes. */
4777 mask, &a);
4778 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4779 }
4780 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4781
4782 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4783 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4784 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4785 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4786 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4787 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4788 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4789 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4790
4791 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4792 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4793 bar->prev = Qnil;
4794 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4795 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4796 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4797
4798 /* Map the window/widget. */
4799 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4800 {
4801 #ifdef USE_GTK
4802 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4803 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4804 top,
4805 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4806 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4807 max (height, 1));
4808 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4809 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4810 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4811 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4812 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4813 top,
4814 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4815 max (height, 1), 0);
4816 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4817 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4818 }
4819 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4820 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4821 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4822
4823 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4824 return bar;
4825 }
4826
4827
4828 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4829
4830 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4831 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4832 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4833 events.)
4834
4835 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4836 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4837 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4838 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4839 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4840
4841 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4842
4843 static void
4844 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4845 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4846 int start, end;
4847 int rebuild;
4848 {
4849 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4850 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4851 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4852 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4853
4854 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4855 if (! rebuild
4856 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4857 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4858 return;
4859
4860 BLOCK_INPUT;
4861
4862 {
4863 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4864 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4865 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4866
4867 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4868 the distance between start and end. */
4869 {
4870 int length = end - start;
4871
4872 if (start < 0)
4873 start = 0;
4874 else if (start > top_range)
4875 start = top_range;
4876 end = start + length;
4877
4878 if (end < start)
4879 end = start;
4880 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4881 end = top_range;
4882 }
4883
4884 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4885 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4886 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4887
4888 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4889 if (end > top_range)
4890 end = top_range;
4891
4892 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4893 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4894 that many pixels tall. */
4895 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4896
4897 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4898 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4899 if (0 < start)
4900 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4901 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4902 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4904 inside_width, start,
4905 False);
4906
4907 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4908 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4909 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4910 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4911
4912 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4913 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4914 /* x, y, width, height */
4915 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4916 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4917 inside_width, end - start);
4918
4919 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4920 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4921 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4922 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4923
4924 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4925 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4926 if (end < inside_height)
4927 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4928 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4929 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4930 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4931 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4932 False);
4933
4934 }
4935
4936 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4937 }
4938
4939 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4940
4941 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4942 nil. */
4943
4944 static void
4945 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4946 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4947 {
4948 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4949 BLOCK_INPUT;
4950
4951 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4952 #ifdef USE_GTK
4953 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4954 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4955 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4956 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4957 #else
4958 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4959 #endif
4960
4961 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4962 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4963
4964 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4965 }
4966
4967
4968 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4969 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4970 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4971 create one. */
4972
4973 static void
4974 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4975 struct window *w;
4976 int portion, whole, position;
4977 {
4978 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4979 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4980 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4981 int window_y, window_height;
4982
4983 /* Get window dimensions. */
4984 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4985 top = window_y;
4986 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4987 height = window_height;
4988
4989 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4990 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4991
4992 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4993 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4994 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4995 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4996 else
4997 sb_width = width;
4998
4999 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5000 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5001 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5002 sb_left = (left +
5003 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5004 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5005 : 0));
5006 else
5007 sb_left = (left +
5008 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5009 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5010 : width - sb_width));
5011 #else
5012 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5013 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5014 else
5015 sb_left = left;
5016 #endif
5017
5018 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5019 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5020 {
5021 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5022 {
5023 BLOCK_INPUT;
5024 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5025 left, top, width, height, False);
5026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5027 }
5028
5029 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5030 }
5031 else
5032 {
5033 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5034 unsigned int mask = 0;
5035
5036 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5037
5038 BLOCK_INPUT;
5039
5040 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5041 mask |= CWX;
5042 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5043 mask |= CWY;
5044 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5045 mask |= CWWidth;
5046 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5047 mask |= CWHeight;
5048
5049 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5050
5051 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5052 if (mask)
5053 {
5054 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5055 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5056 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5057 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5058 left, top, width, height, False);
5059 #ifdef USE_GTK
5060 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5061 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5062 top,
5063 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5064 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5065 max (height, 1));
5066 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5067 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5068 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5069 top,
5070 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5071 max (height, 1), 0);
5072 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5073 }
5074 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5075
5076 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5077 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5078 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5079 {
5080 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5081 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5082 height, False);
5083 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5084 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5085 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5086 height, False);
5087 }
5088
5089 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5090 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5091 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5092 example. */
5093 {
5094 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5095 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5096 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5097 {
5098 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5099 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5100 left + area_width - rest, top,
5101 rest, height, False);
5102 else
5103 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5104 left, top, rest, height, False);
5105 }
5106 }
5107
5108 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5109 if (mask)
5110 {
5111 XWindowChanges wc;
5112
5113 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5114 wc.y = top;
5115 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5116 wc.height = height;
5117 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5118 mask, &wc);
5119 }
5120
5121 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5122
5123 /* Remember new settings. */
5124 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5125 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5126 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5127 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5128
5129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5130 }
5131
5132 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5133 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5134 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5135 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5136 dragged. */
5137 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5138 {
5139 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5140
5141 if (whole == 0)
5142 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5143 else
5144 {
5145 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5146 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5147 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5148 }
5149 }
5150 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5151
5152 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5153 }
5154
5155
5156 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5157 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5158 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5159 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5160 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5161 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5162 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5163
5164 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5165 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5166 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5167
5168 static void
5169 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5170 FRAME_PTR frame;
5171 {
5172 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5173 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5174 {
5175 Lisp_Object bar;
5176 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5177 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5178 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5179 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5180 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5181 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5182 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5183 }
5184 }
5185
5186
5187 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5188 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5189
5190 static void
5191 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5192 struct window *window;
5193 {
5194 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5195 struct frame *f;
5196
5197 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5198 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5199 abort ();
5200
5201 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5202
5203 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5204 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5205 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5206 {
5207 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5208 the lists. */
5209 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5210 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5211 return;
5212 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5213 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5214 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5215 else
5216 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5217 one or the other! */
5218 abort ();
5219 }
5220 else
5221 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5222
5223 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5224 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5225
5226 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5227 bar->prev = Qnil;
5228 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5229 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5230 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5231 }
5232
5233 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5234 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5235
5236 static void
5237 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5238 FRAME_PTR f;
5239 {
5240 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5241
5242 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5243
5244 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5245 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5246 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5247
5248 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5249 {
5250 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5251
5252 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5253
5254 next = b->next;
5255 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5256 }
5257
5258 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5259 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5260 }
5261
5262
5263 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5264 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5265 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5266
5267 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5268 mark bits. */
5269
5270 static void
5271 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5272 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5273 XEvent *event;
5274 {
5275 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5276 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5277 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5278 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5279
5280 BLOCK_INPUT;
5281
5282 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5283
5284 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5285 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5286 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5287 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5288
5289 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5290 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5291
5292 /* x, y, width, height */
5293 0, 0,
5294 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5295 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5296
5297 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5298 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5299 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5300 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
5301
5302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5303
5304 }
5305 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5306
5307 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5308 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5309
5310 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5311 mark bits. */
5312
5313
5314 static void
5315 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5316 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5317 XEvent *event;
5318 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5319 {
5320 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5321 abort ();
5322
5323 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5324 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5325 emacs_event->modifiers
5326 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5327 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5328 event->xbutton.state)
5329 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5330 ? up_modifier
5331 : down_modifier));
5332 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5333 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5334 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5335 {
5336 #if 0
5337 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5338 int internal_height
5339 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5340 #endif
5341 int top_range
5342 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5343 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5344
5345 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5346 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5347
5348 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5349 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5350 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5351 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5352 else
5353 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5354
5355 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5356 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5357 whether or not we're dragging. */
5358 #if 0
5359 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5360 holding it. */
5361 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5362 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5363 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5364 #endif
5365
5366 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5367 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5368 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5369 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5370 {
5371 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5372 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5373
5374 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5375 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5376 }
5377 #endif
5378
5379 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5380 #if 0
5381 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5382 the handle. */
5383 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5384 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5385 else
5386 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5387 #else
5388 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5389 #endif
5390
5391 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5392 }
5393 }
5394
5395 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5396
5397 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5398
5399 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5400 mark bits. */
5401
5402 static void
5403 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5404 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5405 XEvent *event;
5406 {
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5408
5409 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5410
5411 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5412 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5413
5414 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5415 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5416 {
5417 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5418 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5419
5420 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5421 {
5422 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5423
5424 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5425 }
5426 }
5427 }
5428
5429 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5430
5431 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5432 on the scroll bar. */
5433
5434 static void
5435 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5436 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5437 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5438 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5439 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5440 unsigned long *time;
5441 {
5442 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5443 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5444 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5445 int win_x, win_y;
5446 Window dummy_window;
5447 int dummy_coord;
5448 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5449
5450 BLOCK_INPUT;
5451
5452 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5453 report that. */
5454 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5455
5456 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5457 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5458 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5459
5460 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5461 &win_x, &win_y,
5462
5463 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5464 &dummy_mask))
5465 ;
5466 else
5467 {
5468 #if 0
5469 int inside_height
5470 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5471 #endif
5472 int top_range
5473 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5474
5475 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5476
5477 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5478 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5479
5480 if (win_y < 0)
5481 win_y = 0;
5482 if (win_y > top_range)
5483 win_y = top_range;
5484
5485 *fp = f;
5486 *bar_window = bar->window;
5487
5488 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5489 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5490 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5491 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5492 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5493 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5494 else
5495 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5496
5497 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5498 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5499
5500 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5501 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5502 }
5503
5504 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5505
5506 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5507 }
5508
5509
5510 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5511 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5512 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5513 redraw them. */
5514
5515 void
5516 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5517 FRAME_PTR f;
5518 {
5519 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5520 Lisp_Object bar;
5521
5522 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5523 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5524 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5525 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5526 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5527 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5528 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5529 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5530 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5531 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5532 }
5533
5534 \f
5535 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5536
5537 #if 0
5538 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5539 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5540 sometimes don't work. */
5541
5542 static Time enter_timestamp;
5543 #endif
5544
5545 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5546 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5547 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5548 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5549
5550 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5551 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5552
5553 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5554
5555 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5556 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5557
5558 static int temp_index;
5559 static short temp_buffer[100];
5560
5561 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5562 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5563 temp_index = 0; \
5564 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5565
5566 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5567 on a particular display. */
5568
5569 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5570
5571 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5572 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5573 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5574 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5575
5576 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5577
5578 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5579 do \
5580 { \
5581 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5582 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5583 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5584 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5585 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5586 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5587 } \
5588 while (0)
5589
5590 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5591 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5592
5593
5594 enum
5595 {
5596 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5597 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5598 X_EVENT_DROP
5599 };
5600
5601 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5602 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5603 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5604
5605 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5606 this event further.
5607 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5608
5609 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5610 static int
5611 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5612 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5613 XEvent *event;
5614 {
5615 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5616 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5617 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5618 was created. */
5619
5620 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5621 event->xclient.window);
5622
5623 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5624 }
5625 #endif
5626
5627 #ifdef USE_GTK
5628 static int current_count;
5629 static int current_finish;
5630 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5631
5632 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5633 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5634 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5635 static GdkFilterReturn
5636 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5637 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5638 GdkEvent *ev;
5639 gpointer data;
5640 {
5641 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5642
5643 if (current_count >= 0)
5644 {
5645 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5646
5647 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5648
5649 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5650 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5651 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5652 so we do it here. */
5653 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5654 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5655 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5656 #endif
5657
5658 if (! dpyinfo)
5659 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5660 else
5661 {
5662 current_count +=
5663 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5664 current_hold_quit);
5665 }
5666 }
5667 else
5668 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5669
5670 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5671 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5672
5673 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5674 }
5675 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5676
5677
5678 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5679
5680 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5681 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5682 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5683
5684 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5685
5686 static int
5687 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5689 XEvent *eventp;
5690 int *finish;
5691 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5692 {
5693 union {
5694 struct input_event ie;
5695 struct selection_input_event sie;
5696 } inev;
5697 int count = 0;
5698 int do_help = 0;
5699 int nbytes = 0;
5700 struct frame *f;
5701 struct coding_system coding;
5702 XEvent event = *eventp;
5703
5704 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5705
5706 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5707 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5708 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5709
5710 switch (event.type)
5711 {
5712 case ClientMessage:
5713 {
5714 if (event.xclient.message_type
5715 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5716 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5717 {
5718 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5719 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5720 {
5721 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5722 could be the shell widget window
5723 if the frame has no title bar. */
5724 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5725 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5726 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5727 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5728 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5729 #endif
5730 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5731 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5732 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5733 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5734 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5735 needed.
5736
5737 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5738 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5739 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5740 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5741 Emacs. */
5742
5743 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5744 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5745 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5746 if (f)
5747 {
5748 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5749 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5750 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5751 x_catch_errors (d);
5752 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5753 /* The ICCCM says this is
5754 the only valid choice. */
5755 RevertToParent,
5756 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5757 /* This is needed to detect the error
5758 if there is an error. */
5759 XSync (d, False);
5760 x_uncatch_errors ();
5761 }
5762 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5763 #endif /* 0 */
5764 goto done;
5765 }
5766
5767 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5768 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5769 {
5770 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5771 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5772 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5773 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5774 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5775 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5776 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5777 session manager and one for this. */
5778 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5779 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5780 #endif
5781 {
5782 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5783 event.xclient.window);
5784 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5785 for a single Emacs process. */
5786 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5787 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5788 event.xclient.window,
5789 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5790 else if (f)
5791 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5792 event.xclient.window,
5793 0, 0);
5794 }
5795 goto done;
5796 }
5797
5798 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5799 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5800 {
5801 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5802 event.xclient.window);
5803 if (!f)
5804 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5805
5806 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5807 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5808 goto done;
5809 }
5810
5811 goto done;
5812 }
5813
5814 if (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5816 {
5817 goto done;
5818 }
5819
5820 if (event.xclient.message_type
5821 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5822 {
5823 int new_x, new_y;
5824 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5825
5826 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5827 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5828
5829 if (f)
5830 {
5831 f->left_pos = new_x;
5832 f->top_pos = new_y;
5833 }
5834 goto done;
5835 }
5836
5837 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5838 if (event.xclient.message_type
5839 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5840 {
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5842 if (f)
5843 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5844 &event, NULL);
5845 goto done;
5846 }
5847 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5848
5849 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5850 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5851 || (event.xclient.message_type
5852 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5853 {
5854 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5855 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5856 currently never do because we are interested in
5857 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5858 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5859 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5860 if (!f)
5861 goto OTHER;
5862 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5863 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5864 goto done;
5865 }
5866
5867 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5868 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5869 we construct an input_event. */
5870 if (event.xclient.message_type
5871 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5872 {
5873 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5874 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5875 goto done;
5876 }
5877 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5878
5879 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5880 if (!f)
5881 goto OTHER;
5882 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5883 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5884 }
5885 break;
5886
5887 case SelectionNotify:
5888 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5889 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5890 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5891 goto OTHER;
5892 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5893 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5894 break;
5895
5896 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5897 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5898 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5899 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5900 goto OTHER;
5901 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5902 {
5903 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5904
5905 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5906 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5907 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5908 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5909 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5910 }
5911 break;
5912
5913 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5914 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5916 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5917 goto OTHER;
5918 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5919 {
5920 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5921 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5922
5923 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5924 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5925 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5926 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5927 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5928 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5929 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5930 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5931 }
5932 break;
5933
5934 case PropertyNotify:
5935 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5936 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5937 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5938 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5939 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5940 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5941 goto OTHER;
5942 #endif
5943 #endif
5944 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5945 goto OTHER;
5946
5947 case ReparentNotify:
5948 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5949 if (f)
5950 {
5951 int x, y;
5952 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5953 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5954 f->left_pos = x;
5955 f->top_pos = y;
5956
5957 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5958 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5959 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5960 }
5961 goto OTHER;
5962
5963 case Expose:
5964 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5965 if (f)
5966 {
5967 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5968
5969 #ifdef USE_GTK
5970 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5971 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5972 event.xexpose.window,
5973 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5974 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5975 FALSE);
5976 #endif
5977 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5978 {
5979 f->async_visible = 1;
5980 f->async_iconified = 0;
5981 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5982 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5983 }
5984 else
5985 expose_frame (f,
5986 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5987 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5988 }
5989 else
5990 {
5991 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5992 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5993 #endif
5994 #if defined USE_LUCID
5995 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5996 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5997 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5998 {
5999 Widget widget
6000 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6001 if (widget)
6002 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6003 }
6004 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6005
6006 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6007 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6008 goto OTHER;
6009 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6010 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6011 event.xexpose.window);
6012
6013 if (bar)
6014 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6015 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6016 else
6017 goto OTHER;
6018 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6019 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6020 }
6021 break;
6022
6023 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6024 source area was obscured or not
6025 available. */
6026 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6027 if (f)
6028 {
6029 expose_frame (f,
6030 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6031 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6032 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6033 }
6034 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6035 else
6036 goto OTHER;
6037 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6038 break;
6039
6040 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6041 source area was completely
6042 available. */
6043 break;
6044
6045 case UnmapNotify:
6046 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6047 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6048 {
6049 tip_window = 0;
6050 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6051 }
6052
6053 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6054 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6055 the frame was deleted. */
6056 {
6057 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6058 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6059 display that won't ever be seen. */
6060 f->async_visible = 0;
6061 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6062 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6063 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6064 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6065 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6066 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6067 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6068 {
6069 f->async_iconified = 1;
6070
6071 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6072 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6073 }
6074 }
6075 goto OTHER;
6076
6077 case MapNotify:
6078 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6079 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6080 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6081 goto OTHER;
6082
6083 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6084 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6085 frame is visible. */
6086 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6087 if (f)
6088 {
6089 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6090 the frame's display structures.
6091 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6092 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6093 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6094 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6095 if (! f->async_iconified)
6096 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6097
6098 f->async_visible = 1;
6099 f->async_iconified = 0;
6100 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6101
6102 if (f->iconified)
6103 {
6104 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6105 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6106 }
6107 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6108 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6109 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6110 to update the frame titles
6111 in case this is the second frame. */
6112 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6113 }
6114 goto OTHER;
6115
6116 case KeyPress:
6117
6118 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6119 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6120
6121 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6122 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6123 if (popup_activated ())
6124 goto OTHER;
6125 #endif
6126
6127 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6128
6129 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6130 mouse highlighting. */
6131 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6132 && (f == 0
6133 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6134 {
6135 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6136 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6137 }
6138
6139 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6140 if (f == 0)
6141 {
6142 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6143 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6144 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6145 event.xkey.window);
6146 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6147 {
6148 widget = XtParent (widget);
6149 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6150 }
6151 }
6152 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6153
6154 if (f != 0)
6155 {
6156 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6157 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6158 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6159 his Emacs hang.
6160
6161 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6162 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6163 status_return even if the input is too long to
6164 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6165 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6166 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6167 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6168 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6169 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6170 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6171 int modifiers;
6172 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6173 Lisp_Object c;
6174
6175 #ifdef USE_GTK
6176 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6177 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6178 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6179 (see above). */
6180 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6181 #endif
6182
6183 event.xkey.state
6184 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6185 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6186 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6187
6188 /* This will have to go some day... */
6189
6190 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6191 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6192 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6193 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6194 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6195 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6196 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6197
6198 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6199 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6200 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6201 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6202 not it is combined with Meta. */
6203 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6204 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6205
6206 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6207 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6208 {
6209 Status status_return;
6210
6211 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6212 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6213 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6214 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6215 &status_return);
6216 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6217 {
6218 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6219 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6220 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6221 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6222 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6223 &status_return);
6224 }
6225 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6226 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6227 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6228 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6229 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6230 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6231 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6232 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6233 &status_return);
6234 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6235 {
6236 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6237 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6238 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6239 &event.xkey,
6240 copy_bufptr,
6241 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6242 &status_return);
6243 }
6244 }
6245 #endif
6246
6247 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6248 break;
6249 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6250 {
6251 keysym = NoSymbol;
6252 modifiers = 0;
6253 }
6254 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6255 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6256 abort ();
6257 }
6258 else
6259 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6260 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6261 &compose_status);
6262 #else
6263 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6264 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6265 &compose_status);
6266 #endif
6267
6268 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6269 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6270 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6271 break;
6272
6273 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6274 orig_keysym = keysym;
6275
6276 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6277 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6278 inev.ie.modifiers
6279 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6280 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6281
6282 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6283 translations to characters. */
6284 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6285 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6286 {
6287 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6288 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6289 goto done_keysym;
6290 }
6291
6292 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6293 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6294 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6295 {
6296 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6297
6298 if (code < 0x80)
6299 {
6300 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6301 inev.ie.code = code;
6302 }
6303 else if (code < 0x100)
6304 {
6305 if (code < 0xA0)
6306 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6307 else
6308 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6309 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6310 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6311 }
6312 else
6313 {
6314 if (code < 0x2500)
6315 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6316 code -= 0x100;
6317 else if (code < 0xE000)
6318 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6319 code -= 0x2500;
6320 else
6321 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6322 code -= 0xE000;
6323 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6324 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6325 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6326 }
6327 goto done_keysym;
6328 }
6329
6330 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6331 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6332 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6333 Vx_keysym_table,
6334 Qnil))))
6335 {
6336 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6337 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6338 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6339 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6340 goto done_keysym;
6341 }
6342
6343 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6344 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6345 || keysym == XK_Delete
6346 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6347 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6348 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6349 #endif
6350 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6351 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6352 #ifdef HPUX
6353 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6354 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6355 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6356 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6357 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6358 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6380 #endif
6381 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6382 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6383 #endif
6384 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6385 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6386 #endif
6387 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6388 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6389 #endif
6390 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6391 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6392 #endif
6393 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6394 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6395 #endif
6396 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6397 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6398 #endif
6399 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6400 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6401 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6402 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6403 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6404 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6405 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6406 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6407 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6408 #endif
6409 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6410 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6411 #endif
6412 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6413 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6414 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6415 don't have real modifiers but
6416 should be treated similarly to
6417 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6418 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6419 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6420 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6421 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6422 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6423 #endif
6424 ))
6425 {
6426 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6427 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6428 key. */
6429 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6430 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6431 goto done_keysym;
6432 }
6433
6434 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6435 register int i;
6436 register int c;
6437 int nchars, len;
6438
6439 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6440 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6441 we used just above and the locale. */
6442 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6443 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6444 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6445 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6446 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6447 gives us composition information. */
6448 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6449
6450 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6451 {
6452 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6453 }
6454
6455 {
6456 /* Decode the input data. */
6457 int require;
6458 unsigned char *p;
6459
6460 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6461 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6462 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6463 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6464 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6465 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6466 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6467 nbytes = coding.produced;
6468 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6469 copy_bufptr = p;
6470 }
6471
6472 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6473 character events. */
6474 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6475 {
6476 if (nchars == nbytes)
6477 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6478 else
6479 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6480 nbytes - i, len);
6481 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6482 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6483 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6484 inev.ie.code = c;
6485 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6489 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6490 count += nbytes;
6491
6492 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6493
6494 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6495 break;
6496 }
6497 }
6498 done_keysym:
6499 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6500 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6501 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6502 client. */
6503 break;
6504 #else
6505 goto OTHER;
6506 #endif
6507
6508 case KeyRelease:
6509 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6510 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6511 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6512 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6513 client. */
6514 break;
6515 #else
6516 goto OTHER;
6517 #endif
6518
6519 case EnterNotify:
6520 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6521 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6522
6523 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6524
6525 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6526 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6527
6528 #if 0
6529 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6530 {
6531 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6532 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6533 || !(f->auto_lower)
6534 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6535 {
6536 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6537 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6538 }
6539 }
6540 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6541 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6542 #endif
6543
6544 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6545 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6546 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6547 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6548 #ifdef USE_GTK
6549 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6550 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6551 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6552 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6553 #endif
6554 goto OTHER;
6555
6556 case FocusIn:
6557 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6558 goto OTHER;
6559
6560 case LeaveNotify:
6561 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6562 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6563
6564 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6565 if (f)
6566 {
6567 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6568 {
6569 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6570 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6571 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6572 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6573 }
6574
6575 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6576 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6577 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6578 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6579 if (any_help_event_p)
6580 do_help = -1;
6581 }
6582 #ifdef USE_GTK
6583 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6584 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6585 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6586 #endif
6587 goto OTHER;
6588
6589 case FocusOut:
6590 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6591 goto OTHER;
6592
6593 case MotionNotify:
6594 {
6595 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6596 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6597 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6598
6599 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6600 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6601 f = last_mouse_frame;
6602 else
6603 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6604
6605 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6606 {
6607 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6608 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6609 }
6610
6611 if (f)
6612 {
6613
6614 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6615 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6616 {
6617 Lisp_Object window;
6618
6619 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6620 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6621 0, 0, 0, 0);
6622
6623 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6624 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6625 will be selected iff it is active. */
6626 if (WINDOWP (window)
6627 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6628 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6629 {
6630 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6631 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6632 }
6633
6634 last_window=window;
6635 }
6636 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6637 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6638 }
6639 else
6640 {
6641 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6642 struct scroll_bar *bar
6643 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6644 event.xmotion.window);
6645
6646 if (bar)
6647 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6648 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6649
6650 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6651 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6652 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6653 }
6654
6655 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6656 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6657 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6658 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6659 do_help = 1;
6660 goto OTHER;
6661 }
6662
6663 case ConfigureNotify:
6664 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6665 if (f)
6666 {
6667 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6668 #ifdef USE_GTK
6669 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6670 event.xconfigure.height);
6671 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6672 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6673 do this one, the right one will come later.
6674 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6675 need to reset it below. */
6676 int dont_resize
6677 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6678 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6679 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6680 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6681
6682 if (dont_resize)
6683 goto OTHER;
6684
6685 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6686 is called by the code that handles resizing
6687 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6688
6689 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6690 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6691 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6692 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6693 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6694 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6695 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6696 {
6697 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6698 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6699 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6700 }
6701 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6702 #endif
6703
6704 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6705 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6706
6707 #ifdef USE_GTK
6708 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6709 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6710 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6711 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6712 #endif
6713 {
6714 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6715
6716 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6717 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6718 }
6719
6720 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6721 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6722 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6723 #endif
6724
6725 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6726 {
6727 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6728 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6729 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6730 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6731 }
6732 }
6733 goto OTHER;
6734
6735 case ButtonRelease:
6736 case ButtonPress:
6737 {
6738 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6739 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6740 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6741
6742 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6743 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6744 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6745
6746 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6747 && last_mouse_frame
6748 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6749 f = last_mouse_frame;
6750 else
6751 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6752
6753 if (f)
6754 {
6755 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6756 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6757 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6758 {
6759 Lisp_Object window;
6760 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6761 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6762
6763 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6764 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6765
6766 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6767 {
6768 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6769 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6770 else
6771 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6772 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6773 event.xbutton.state));
6774 }
6775 }
6776
6777 if (!tool_bar_p)
6778 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6779 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6780 {
6781 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6782 if (! popup_activated ())
6783 #endif
6784 {
6785 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6786 {
6787 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6788 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6789 {
6790 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6791 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6792 }
6793 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6794 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6795 }
6796 else
6797 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6798 }
6799 }
6800 }
6801 else
6802 {
6803 struct scroll_bar *bar
6804 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6805 event.xbutton.window);
6806
6807 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6808 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6809 scroll bars. */
6810 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6811 {
6812 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6813 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6814 }
6815 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6816 if (bar)
6817 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6818 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6819 }
6820
6821 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6822 {
6823 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6824 last_mouse_frame = f;
6825
6826 if (!tool_bar_p)
6827 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6828 }
6829 else
6830 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6831
6832 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6833 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6834 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6835 if (f != 0)
6836 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6837
6838 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6839 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6840 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6841 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6842 Instead, save it away
6843 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6844 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6845 if (
6846 #ifdef USE_GTK
6847 ! popup_activated ()
6848 &&
6849 #endif
6850 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6851 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6852 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6853 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6854 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6855 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6856 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6857 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6858 {
6859 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6860 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6861 #ifdef USE_GTK
6862 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6863 #endif
6864 }
6865 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6866 {
6867 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6868 goto OTHER;
6869 }
6870
6871 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6872 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6873 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6874 {
6875 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6876 {
6877 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6878 if (f->output_data.x)
6879 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6880 }
6881 else
6882 goto OTHER;
6883 }
6884 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6885 else
6886 goto OTHER;
6887 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6888 }
6889 break;
6890
6891 case CirculateNotify:
6892 goto OTHER;
6893
6894 case CirculateRequest:
6895 goto OTHER;
6896
6897 case VisibilityNotify:
6898 goto OTHER;
6899
6900 case MappingNotify:
6901 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6902 local cache. */
6903 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6904 {
6905 case MappingModifier:
6906 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6907 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6908 case MappingKeyboard:
6909 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6910 }
6911 goto OTHER;
6912
6913 default:
6914 OTHER:
6915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6916 BLOCK_INPUT;
6917 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6918 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6920 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6921 break;
6922 }
6923
6924 done:
6925 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6926 {
6927 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6928 count++;
6929 }
6930
6931 if (do_help
6932 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6933 {
6934 Lisp_Object frame;
6935
6936 if (f)
6937 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6938 else
6939 frame = Qnil;
6940
6941 if (do_help > 0)
6942 {
6943 any_help_event_p = 1;
6944 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6945 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6946 }
6947 else
6948 {
6949 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6950 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6951 }
6952 count++;
6953 }
6954
6955 *eventp = event;
6956 return count;
6957 }
6958
6959
6960 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6961 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6962 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6963
6964 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6965 int
6966 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6967 XEvent *event;
6968 Display *display;
6969 {
6970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6971 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6972
6973 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6974
6975 if (dpyinfo)
6976 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6977
6978 return finish;
6979 }
6980
6981
6982 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6983 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6984 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6985
6986 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6987 thus pretending to be `read'.
6988
6989 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6990
6991 static int
6992 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6993 register int sd;
6994 int expected;
6995 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6996 {
6997 int count = 0;
6998 XEvent event;
6999 int event_found = 0;
7000 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7001
7002 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7003 {
7004 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7005 return -1;
7006 }
7007
7008 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7009 BLOCK_INPUT;
7010
7011 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7012 input_signal_count++;
7013
7014 ++handling_signal;
7015
7016 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7017 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7018 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7019 {
7020 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7021 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7022 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7023 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7024 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7025 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7026 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7027 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7028 #endif
7029
7030 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7031 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7032 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7033 for X connections. */
7034 #ifndef SIGIO
7035 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7036 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7037 {
7038 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7039 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7040 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7041 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7042 }
7043 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7044 #endif /* SIGIO */
7045 #endif
7046
7047 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7048 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7049 {
7050 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7051 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7052 }
7053
7054 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7055 {
7056 struct input_event inev;
7057 BLOCK_INPUT;
7058 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7059 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7060 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7061 {
7062 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7063 count++;
7064 }
7065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7066 }
7067 #endif
7068
7069 #ifndef USE_GTK
7070 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7071 {
7072 int finish;
7073
7074 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7075
7076 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7077 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7078 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7079 break;
7080 #endif
7081 event_found = 1;
7082
7083 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7084
7085 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7086 goto out;
7087 }
7088 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7089 }
7090
7091 #ifdef USE_GTK
7092
7093 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7094 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7095 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7096 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7097
7098 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7099 from all displays. */
7100
7101 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7102 {
7103 current_count = count;
7104 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7105
7106 gtk_main_iteration ();
7107
7108 count = current_count;
7109 current_count = -1;
7110 current_hold_quit = 0;
7111
7112 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7113 break;
7114 }
7115 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7116
7117 out:;
7118
7119 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7120 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7121 if (! event_found)
7122 {
7123 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7124 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7125 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7126 x_noop_count++;
7127 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7128 {
7129 x_noop_count=0;
7130
7131 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7132 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7133
7134 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7135
7136 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7137 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7138 }
7139 }
7140
7141 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7142 raise it now. */
7143 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7144 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7145 {
7146 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7147 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7148 }
7149
7150 --handling_signal;
7151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7152
7153 return count;
7154 }
7155
7156
7157
7158 \f
7159 /***********************************************************************
7160 Text Cursor
7161 ***********************************************************************/
7162
7163 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7164 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7165
7166 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7167 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7168 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7169
7170 static void
7171 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7172 struct window *w;
7173 struct glyph_row *row;
7174 int area;
7175 GC gc;
7176 {
7177 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7178 XRectangle clip_rect;
7179 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7180
7181 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7182
7183 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7184 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7185 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7186 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7187 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7188
7189 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7190 }
7191
7192
7193 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7194
7195 static void
7196 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7197 struct window *w;
7198 struct glyph_row *row;
7199 {
7200 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7201 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7202 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7203 int x, y, wd, h;
7204 XGCValues xgcv;
7205 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7206 GC gc;
7207
7208 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7209 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7210 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7211 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7212 return;
7213
7214 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7215 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7216 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7217
7218 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7219 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7220 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7221 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7222 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7223 else
7224 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7225 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7226 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7227
7228 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7229 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7230 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7231 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7232 }
7233
7234
7235 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7236
7237 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7238 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7239 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7240 --gerd. */
7241
7242 static void
7243 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7244 struct window *w;
7245 struct glyph_row *row;
7246 int width;
7247 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7248 {
7249 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7250 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7251
7252 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7253 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7254 and mini-buffer. */
7255 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7256 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7257 return;
7258
7259 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7260 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7261 the bar might not be in the window. */
7262 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7263 {
7264 struct glyph_row *row;
7265 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7266 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7267 }
7268 else
7269 {
7270 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7271 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7272 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7273 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7274 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7275 XGCValues xgcv;
7276
7277 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7278 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7279 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7280 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7281 that the glyph is legible. */
7282 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7283 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7284 else
7285 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7286 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7287
7288 if (gc)
7289 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7290 else
7291 {
7292 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7293 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7294 }
7295
7296 if (width < 0)
7297 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7298 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7299
7300 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7301 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7302
7303 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7304 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7305 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7306 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7307 width, row->height);
7308 else
7309 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7310 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7311 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7312 row->height - width),
7313 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7314 width);
7315
7316 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7317 }
7318 }
7319
7320
7321 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7322
7323 static void
7324 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7325 struct frame *f;
7326 Cursor cursor;
7327 {
7328 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7329 }
7330
7331
7332 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7333
7334 static void
7335 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7336 struct frame *f;
7337 int x, y, width, height;
7338 {
7339 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7340 x, y, width, height, False);
7341 }
7342
7343
7344 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7345
7346 static void
7347 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7348 struct window *w;
7349 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7350 int x, y;
7351 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7352 int on_p, active_p;
7353 {
7354 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7355
7356 if (on_p)
7357 {
7358 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7359 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7360
7361 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7362 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7363 {
7364 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7365 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7366 }
7367 else
7368 switch (cursor_type)
7369 {
7370 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7371 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7372 break;
7373
7374 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7375 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7376 break;
7377
7378 case BAR_CURSOR:
7379 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7380 break;
7381
7382 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7383 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7384 break;
7385
7386 case NO_CURSOR:
7387 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7388 break;
7389
7390 default:
7391 abort ();
7392 }
7393
7394 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7395 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7396 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7397 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7398 #endif
7399 }
7400
7401 #ifndef XFlush
7402 if (updating_frame != f)
7403 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7404 #endif
7405 }
7406
7407 \f
7408 /* Icons. */
7409
7410 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7411
7412 int
7413 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7414 struct frame *f;
7415 Lisp_Object file;
7416 {
7417 int bitmap_id;
7418
7419 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7420 return 1;
7421
7422 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7423 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7424 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7425 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7426
7427 if (STRINGP (file))
7428 {
7429 #ifdef USE_GTK
7430 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7431 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7432 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7433 return 0;
7434 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7435 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7436 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7437 }
7438 else
7439 {
7440 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7441 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7442 {
7443 int rc = -1;
7444
7445 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7446 #ifdef USE_GTK
7447 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7448 return 0;
7449 #else
7450 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7451 if (rc != -1)
7452 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7453 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7454 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7455
7456 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7457 if (rc == -1)
7458 {
7459 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7460 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7461 if (rc == -1)
7462 return 1;
7463
7464 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7465 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7466 }
7467 }
7468
7469 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7470 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7471 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7472 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7473 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7474
7475 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7476 }
7477
7478 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7479 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7480
7481 return 0;
7482 }
7483
7484
7485 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7486 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7487
7488 int
7489 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7490 struct frame *f;
7491 char *icon_name;
7492 {
7493 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7494 return 1;
7495
7496 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7497 {
7498 XTextProperty text;
7499 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7500 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7501 text.format = 8;
7502 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7503 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7504 }
7505 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7506 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7507 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7508
7509 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7511 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7512 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7513
7514 return 0;
7515 }
7516 \f
7517 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7518
7519 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7520 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7521
7522 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7523 be called from a signal handler.
7524 */
7525
7526 struct x_error_message_stack {
7527 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7528 Display *dpy;
7529 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7530 };
7531 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7532
7533 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7534 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7535 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7536
7537 static void
7538 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7539 Display *display;
7540 XErrorEvent *error;
7541 {
7542 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7543 x_error_message->string,
7544 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7545 }
7546
7547 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7548 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7549 operating on.
7550
7551 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7552 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7553 stored in *x_error_message.
7554
7555 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7556 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7557
7558 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7559
7560 void x_check_errors ();
7561
7562 void
7563 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7564 Display *dpy;
7565 {
7566 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7567
7568 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7569 XSync (dpy, False);
7570
7571 data->dpy = dpy;
7572 data->string[0] = 0;
7573 data->prev = x_error_message;
7574 x_error_message = data;
7575 }
7576
7577 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7578 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7579
7580 void
7581 x_uncatch_errors ()
7582 {
7583 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7584
7585 BLOCK_INPUT;
7586
7587 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7588 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7589 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7590 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7591
7592 tmp = x_error_message;
7593 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7594 xfree (tmp);
7595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7596 }
7597
7598 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7599 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7600 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7601
7602 void
7603 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7604 Display *dpy;
7605 char *format;
7606 {
7607 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7608 XSync (dpy, False);
7609
7610 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7611 {
7612 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7613 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7614 x_uncatch_errors ();
7615 error (format, string);
7616 }
7617 }
7618
7619 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7620 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7621
7622 int
7623 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7624 Display *dpy;
7625 {
7626 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7627 XSync (dpy, False);
7628
7629 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7630 }
7631
7632 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7633
7634 void
7635 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7636 Display *dpy;
7637 {
7638 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7639 }
7640
7641 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7642
7643 void
7644 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7645 {
7646 while (x_error_message)
7647 x_uncatch_errors ();
7648 }
7649
7650 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7651
7652 int
7653 x_catching_errors ()
7654 {
7655 return x_error_message != 0;
7656 }
7657
7658 #if 0
7659 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7660 x_trace_wire ()
7661 {
7662 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7663 }
7664 #endif /* ! 0 */
7665
7666 \f
7667 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7668 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7669 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7670 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7671 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7672
7673 static SIGTYPE
7674 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7675 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7676 {
7677 #ifdef USG
7678 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7679 must reestablish each time */
7680 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7681 #endif /* USG */
7682 }
7683
7684 \f
7685 /************************************************************************
7686 Handling X errors
7687 ************************************************************************/
7688
7689 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7690
7691 static char *error_msg;
7692
7693 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7694 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7695 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7696
7697 static void
7698 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7699 {
7700 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7701 exit (70);
7702 }
7703
7704 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7705 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7706
7707 static SIGTYPE
7708 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7709 Display *dpy;
7710 char *error_message;
7711 {
7712 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7713 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7714
7715 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7716 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7717 handling_signal = 0;
7718
7719 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7720 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7721 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7722 the original message here. */
7723 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7724
7725 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7726 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7727 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7728
7729 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7730 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7731 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7732
7733 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7734 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7735
7736 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7737 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7738 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7739
7740 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7741 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7742 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7743 if (dpyinfo)
7744 {
7745 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7746 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7747 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7748 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7749 }
7750 #endif
7751
7752 #ifdef USE_GTK
7753 if (dpyinfo)
7754 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7755 #endif
7756
7757 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7758 if (dpyinfo)
7759 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7760
7761 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7762 that are on the dead display. */
7763 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7764 {
7765 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7766 minibuf_frame
7767 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7768 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7769 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7770 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7771 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7772 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7773 }
7774
7775 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7776 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7777 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7778 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7779 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7780 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7781 {
7782 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7783 trying to find a replacement. */
7784 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7785 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7786 }
7787
7788 if (dpyinfo)
7789 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7790
7791 x_uncatch_errors ();
7792
7793 if (x_display_list == 0)
7794 {
7795 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7796 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7797 exit (70);
7798 }
7799
7800 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7801 #ifdef SIGIO
7802 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7803 #endif
7804 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7805 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7806
7807 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7808 error ("%s", error_msg);
7809 }
7810
7811 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7812 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7813 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7814
7815 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7816 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7817
7818 static int
7819 x_error_handler (display, error)
7820 Display *display;
7821 XErrorEvent *error;
7822 {
7823 if (x_error_message)
7824 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7825 else
7826 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7827 return 0;
7828 }
7829
7830 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7831 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7832 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7833
7834 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7835
7836 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7837 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7838 #else
7839 #define NO_INLINE
7840 #endif
7841
7842 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7843
7844 #ifdef noinline
7845 #undef noinline
7846 #endif
7847
7848 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7849 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7850
7851 static void NO_INLINE
7852 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7853 Display *display;
7854 XErrorEvent *error;
7855 {
7856 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7857
7858 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7859 or colors that are not defined. */
7860
7861 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7862 return;
7863
7864 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7865 original error handler. */
7866
7867 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7868 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7869 buf, error->request_code);
7870 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7871 }
7872
7873
7874 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7875 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7876 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7877
7878 static int
7879 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7880 Display *display;
7881 {
7882 char buf[256];
7883
7884 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7885 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7886 return 0;
7887 }
7888 \f
7889 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7890
7891 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7892 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7893 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7894 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7895
7896 Lisp_Object
7897 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7898 struct frame *f;
7899 register char *fontname;
7900 {
7901 struct font_info *fontp
7902 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7903
7904 if (!fontp)
7905 return Qnil;
7906
7907 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7908 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7909 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7910
7911 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7912 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7913 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7914
7915 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7916
7917 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7918 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7919 {
7920 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7921 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7922 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7923 }
7924 else
7925 {
7926 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7927 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7928 }
7929
7930 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7931 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7932 {
7933 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7934 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7935 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7936 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7937 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7938 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7939
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7944 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7945 }
7946
7947 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7948 }
7949
7950 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7951 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7952 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7953 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7954
7955 Lisp_Object
7956 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7957 struct frame *f;
7958 char *fontsetname;
7959 {
7960 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7961 Lisp_Object result;
7962
7963 if (fontset < 0)
7964 return Qnil;
7965
7966 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7967 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7968 to do. */
7969 return fontset_name (fontset);
7970
7971 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7972
7973 if (!STRINGP (result))
7974 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7975 return Qnil;
7976
7977 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7978 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7979
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7981 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7982 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7983 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7984 #endif
7985
7986 return build_string (fontsetname);
7987 }
7988
7989 \f
7990 /***********************************************************************
7991 X Input Methods
7992 ***********************************************************************/
7993
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7995
7996 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7997
7998 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7999 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8000 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8001
8002 static void
8003 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8004 XIM xim;
8005 XPointer client_data;
8006 XPointer call_data;
8007 {
8008 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8009 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8010
8011 BLOCK_INPUT;
8012
8013 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8014 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8015 {
8016 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8017 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8018 {
8019 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8020 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8021 }
8022 }
8023
8024 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8025 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8026 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8027 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8028 }
8029
8030 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8031
8032 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8033 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8034 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8035 #endif
8036
8037 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8038 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8039
8040 static void
8041 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8042 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8043 char *resource_name;
8044 {
8045 XIM xim;
8046
8047 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8048 if (use_xim)
8049 {
8050 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8051 EMACS_CLASS);
8052 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8053
8054 if (xim)
8055 {
8056 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8057 XIMCallback destroy;
8058 #endif
8059
8060 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8061 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8062
8063 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8064 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8065 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8066 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8067 #endif
8068 }
8069 }
8070
8071 else
8072 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8073 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8074 }
8075
8076
8077 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8078
8079 struct xim_inst_t
8080 {
8081 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8082 char *resource_name;
8083 };
8084
8085 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8086 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8087 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8088 when the callback was registered. */
8089
8090 static void
8091 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8092 Display *display;
8093 XPointer client_data;
8094 XPointer call_data;
8095 {
8096 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8097 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8098
8099 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8100 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8101 return;
8102
8103 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8104
8105 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8106 as they have no XIC. */
8107 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8108 {
8109 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8110
8111 BLOCK_INPUT;
8112 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8113 {
8114 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8115
8116 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8117 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8118 {
8119 create_frame_xic (f);
8120 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8121 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8122 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8123 {
8124 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8125 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8126 }
8127 }
8128 }
8129
8130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8131 }
8132 }
8133
8134 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8135
8136
8137 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8138 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8139 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8140 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8141
8142 static void
8143 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8144 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8145 char *resource_name;
8146 {
8147 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8148 if (use_xim)
8149 {
8150 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8151 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8152 int len;
8153
8154 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8155 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8156 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8157 len = strlen (resource_name);
8158 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8159 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8160 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8161 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8162 xim_instantiate_callback,
8163 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8164 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8165 least, hence the configure test. */
8166 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8167 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8168 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8169 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8170 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8171
8172 }
8173 else
8174 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8175 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8176 }
8177
8178
8179 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8180
8181 static void
8182 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8183 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8184 {
8185 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8186 if (use_xim)
8187 {
8188 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8189 if (dpyinfo->display)
8190 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8191 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8192 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8193 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8194 if (dpyinfo->display)
8195 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8196 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8197 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8198 }
8199 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8200 }
8201
8202 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8203
8204
8205 \f
8206 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8207 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8208
8209 void
8210 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8211 struct frame *f;
8212 {
8213 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8214
8215 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8216 is already for the top-left corner. */
8217 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8218 return;
8219
8220 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8221 position that fits on the screen. */
8222 if (flags & XNegative)
8223 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8224 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8225
8226 {
8227 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8228
8229 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8230 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8231 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8232
8233 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8234 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8235 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8236 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8237 is right, though.
8238
8239 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8240 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8241
8242 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8243 #endif
8244
8245 if (flags & YNegative)
8246 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8247 }
8248
8249 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8250 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8251 so the flags should correspond. */
8252 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8253 }
8254
8255 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8256 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8257 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8258 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8259 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8260
8261 void
8262 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8263 struct frame *f;
8264 register int xoff, yoff;
8265 int change_gravity;
8266 {
8267 int modified_top, modified_left;
8268
8269 if (change_gravity != 0)
8270 {
8271 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8272 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8273
8274 f->top_pos = yoff;
8275 f->left_pos = xoff;
8276 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8277 if (xoff < 0)
8278 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8279 if (yoff < 0)
8280 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8281 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8282 }
8283 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8284
8285 BLOCK_INPUT;
8286 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8287
8288 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8289 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8290
8291 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8292 {
8293 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8294 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8295 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8296 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8297 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8298 }
8299
8300 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8301 modified_left, modified_top);
8302
8303 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8304 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8305 ? 1 : 0);
8306
8307 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8308 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8309 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8310 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8311 of the frame.
8312
8313 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8314 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8315 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8316
8317 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8318 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8319 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8320 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8321 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8322 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8323
8324 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8325 }
8326
8327 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8328 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8329 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8330 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8331 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec. */
8332
8333 static int
8334 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8335 struct frame *f;
8336 const char *atomname;
8337 {
8338 Atom actual_type;
8339 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8340 int i, rc, actual_format;
8341 Atom prop_atom;
8342 Window wmcheck_window;
8343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8344 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8345 long max_len = 65536;
8346 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8347 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8348 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8349 Atom want_atom;
8350
8351 BLOCK_INPUT;
8352
8353 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8354
8355 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8356 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8357 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8358 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8359 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8360
8361 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8362 {
8363 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8364 x_uncatch_errors ();
8365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8366 return 0;
8367 }
8368
8369 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8370 XFree (tmp_data);
8371
8372 /* Check if window exists. */
8373 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8374 x_sync (f);
8375 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8376 {
8377 x_uncatch_errors ();
8378 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8379 return 0;
8380 }
8381
8382 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8383 {
8384 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8385 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8386 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8387 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8388 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8389 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8390
8391 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8392 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8393 tmp_data = NULL;
8394 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8395 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8396 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8397 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8398
8399 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8400 {
8401 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8402 x_uncatch_errors ();
8403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8404 return 0;
8405 }
8406
8407 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8408 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8409 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8410 }
8411
8412 rc = 0;
8413 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8414
8415 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8416 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8417
8418 x_uncatch_errors ();
8419 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8420
8421 return rc;
8422 }
8423
8424 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8425
8426 static int
8427 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8428 struct frame *f;
8429 {
8430 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8431
8432 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8433 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8434 if (!have_net_atom)
8435 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8436
8437 if (have_net_atom)
8438 {
8439 Lisp_Object frame;
8440 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8441 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8442 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8443 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8444 const char *what = NULL;
8445
8446 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8447
8448 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8449 hints. */
8450 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8451 {
8452 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8453 what = fs;
8454 break;
8455 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8456 what = fw;
8457 break;
8458 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8459 what = fh;
8460 break;
8461 }
8462
8463 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8464
8465
8466 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8467 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8468 make_number (32),
8469 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8470 Fcons
8471 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8472 strlen (fs)),
8473 Qnil)));
8474 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8475 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8476 make_number (32),
8477 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8478 Fcons
8479 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8480 strlen (fh)),
8481 Qnil)));
8482 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8483 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8484 make_number (32),
8485 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8486 Fcons
8487 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8488 strlen (fw)),
8489 Qnil)));
8490 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8491 if (what != NULL)
8492 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8493 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8494 make_number (32),
8495 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8496 Fcons
8497 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8498 strlen (what)),
8499 Qnil)));
8500 }
8501
8502 return have_net_atom;
8503 }
8504
8505 static void
8506 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8507 FRAME_PTR f;
8508 {
8509 if (f->async_visible)
8510 {
8511 BLOCK_INPUT;
8512 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8513 x_sync (f);
8514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8515 }
8516 }
8517
8518
8519 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8520 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8521 static void
8522 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8523 struct frame *f;
8524 {
8525 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8526 {
8527 int width, height, ign;
8528
8529 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8530 return;
8531
8532 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8533
8534 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8535
8536 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8537 when setting WM manager hints.
8538 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8539 x_check_expected_move. */
8540 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8541 {
8542 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8543 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8544 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8545
8546 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8547 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8548 }
8549 }
8550 }
8551
8552 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8553 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8554 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8555 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8556 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8557 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8558 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8559
8560 static void
8561 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8562 struct frame *f;
8563 int expected_left;
8564 int expected_top;
8565 {
8566 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8567
8568 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8569 window manager window around the frame. */
8570
8571 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8572
8573 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8574 {
8575 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8576
8577 int adjusted_left;
8578 int adjusted_top;
8579
8580 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8581 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8582 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8583
8584 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8585
8586 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8587 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8588
8589 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8590 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8591
8592 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8593 }
8594 else
8595 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8596 frame's position. */
8597
8598 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8599 }
8600
8601
8602 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8603 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8604 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8605 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8606 of an exact comparison. */
8607
8608 static void
8609 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8610 struct frame *f;
8611 int left, top, fuzzy;
8612 {
8613 int count = 0;
8614
8615 while (count++ < 50)
8616 {
8617 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8618
8619 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8620 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8621 loop. */
8622
8623 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8624 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8625
8626 if (fuzzy)
8627 {
8628 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8629 pixels. */
8630
8631 if (abs (current_left - left) <= 10 && abs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8632 return;
8633 }
8634 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8635 return;
8636 }
8637
8638 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8639 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8640
8641 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8642 }
8643
8644
8645 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8646 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8647 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8648 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8649
8650 static void
8651 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8652 struct frame *f;
8653 int change_gravity;
8654 int cols, rows;
8655 {
8656 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8657
8658 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8659 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8660 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8661 ? 0
8662 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8663 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8664 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8665
8666 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8667
8668 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8669 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8670
8671 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8672 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8673
8674 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8675 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8676 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8677
8678 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8679 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8680 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8681 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8682
8683 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8684 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8685 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8686 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8687 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8688
8689 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8690 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8691 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8692 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8693 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8694
8695 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8696 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8697 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8698 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8699 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8700
8701 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8702 }
8703
8704
8705 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8706 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8707 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8708 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8709
8710 void
8711 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8712 struct frame *f;
8713 int change_gravity;
8714 int cols, rows;
8715 {
8716 BLOCK_INPUT;
8717
8718 #ifdef USE_GTK
8719 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8720 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8721 else
8722 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8723 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8724
8725 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8726 {
8727 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8728 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8729 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8730 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8731 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8732 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8733 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8734 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8735 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8736 }
8737 else
8738 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8739
8740 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8741
8742 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8743
8744 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8745
8746 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8747 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8748
8749 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8750 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8751 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8752 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8753 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8754
8755 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8756 }
8757 \f
8758 /* Mouse warping. */
8759
8760 void
8761 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8762 struct frame *f;
8763 int x, y;
8764 {
8765 int pix_x, pix_y;
8766
8767 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8768 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8769
8770 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8771 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8772
8773 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8774 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8775
8776 BLOCK_INPUT;
8777
8778 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8779 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8780 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8784
8785 void
8786 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8787 struct frame *f;
8788 int pix_x, pix_y;
8789 {
8790 BLOCK_INPUT;
8791
8792 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8793 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8795 }
8796 \f
8797 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8798
8799 void
8800 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8801 struct frame *f;
8802 {
8803 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8804 x_raise_frame (f);
8805 #endif
8806 #if 0
8807 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8808 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8809 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8810 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8811 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8812 #endif /* ! 0 */
8813 }
8814
8815 void
8816 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8817 struct frame *f;
8818 {
8819 #if 0
8820 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8821 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8822 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8823 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8824 #endif /* ! 0 */
8825 }
8826
8827 /* Raise frame F. */
8828
8829 void
8830 x_raise_frame (f)
8831 struct frame *f;
8832 {
8833 BLOCK_INPUT;
8834 if (f->async_visible)
8835 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8836
8837 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8838 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8839 }
8840
8841 /* Lower frame F. */
8842
8843 void
8844 x_lower_frame (f)
8845 struct frame *f;
8846 {
8847 if (f->async_visible)
8848 {
8849 BLOCK_INPUT;
8850 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8851 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8853 }
8854 }
8855
8856 static void
8857 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8858 FRAME_PTR f;
8859 int raise_flag;
8860 {
8861 if (raise_flag)
8862 {
8863 /* The following code is needed for `raise-frame' to work on
8864 some versions of metacity; see Window Manager
8865 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8866 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec */
8867
8868 #if 0
8869 /* However, on other versions (metacity 2.17.2-1.fc7), it
8870 reportedly causes hangs when resizing frames. */
8871
8872 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8873 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8874 {
8875 Lisp_Object frame;
8876 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8877 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8878 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8879 make_number (32),
8880 Fcons (make_number (1),
8881 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8882 Qnil)));
8883 }
8884 else
8885 #endif
8886 x_raise_frame (f);
8887 }
8888 else
8889 x_lower_frame (f);
8890 }
8891 \f
8892 /* Change of visibility. */
8893
8894 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8895 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8896 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8897 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8898 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8899 finishes with it. */
8900
8901 void
8902 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8903 struct frame *f;
8904 {
8905 Lisp_Object type;
8906 int original_top, original_left;
8907 int retry_count = 2;
8908
8909 retry:
8910
8911 BLOCK_INPUT;
8912
8913 type = x_icon_type (f);
8914 if (!NILP (type))
8915 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8916
8917 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8918 {
8919 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8920 call x_set_offset a second time
8921 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8922 before the window gets really visible. */
8923 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8924 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8925 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8926
8927 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8928
8929 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8930 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8931 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8932 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8933 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8934 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8935 #ifdef USE_GTK
8936 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8937 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8938 #else
8939 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8940 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8941 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8942 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8943 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8944 to come back ok without this. */
8945 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8946 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8947 #endif
8948 }
8949
8950 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8951
8952 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8953 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8954 so that incoming events are handled. */
8955 {
8956 Lisp_Object frame;
8957 int count;
8958 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8959 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8960 will set it when they are handled. */
8961 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8962
8963 original_left = f->left_pos;
8964 original_top = f->top_pos;
8965
8966 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8967 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8968
8969 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8970
8971 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8972 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8973 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8974 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8975
8976 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8977 because the window manager may choose the position
8978 and we don't want to override it. */
8979
8980 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8981 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8982 && previously_visible)
8983 {
8984 Drawable rootw;
8985 int x, y;
8986 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8987
8988 BLOCK_INPUT;
8989
8990 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8991 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8992 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8993 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8994 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8995 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8996 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8997 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8998 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8999
9000 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9001 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9002 original_left, original_top);
9003
9004 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9005 }
9006
9007 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9008
9009 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9010 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9011 MapNotify at all.. */
9012 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9013 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9014 {
9015 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9016 x_sync (f);
9017
9018 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9019 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9020 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9021 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9022 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9023 probably a bug. */
9024 if (input_polling_used ())
9025 {
9026 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9027 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9028 handler reset it. */
9029 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9030 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9031 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9032 poll_for_input_1 ();
9033 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9034 }
9035
9036 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9037 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9038 }
9039
9040 /* 2000-09-28: In
9041
9042 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9043 (iconify-frame f)
9044 (raise-frame f))
9045
9046 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9047 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9048 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9049 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9050
9051 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9052 goto retry;
9053 }
9054 }
9055
9056 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9057
9058 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9059
9060 void
9061 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9062 struct frame *f;
9063 {
9064 Window window;
9065
9066 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9067 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9068
9069 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9070 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9071 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9072
9073 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9074 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
9075 return;
9076 #endif
9077
9078 BLOCK_INPUT;
9079
9080 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9081 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9082 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9083 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9084 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9085 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9086
9087 #ifdef USE_GTK
9088 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9089 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9090 else
9091 #endif
9092 {
9093 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9094
9095 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9096 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9097 {
9098 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9099 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9100 }
9101 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9102
9103 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
9104 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9105 {
9106 XEvent unmap;
9107
9108 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
9109 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
9110 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9111 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
9112 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9113 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9114 False,
9115 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
9116 &unmap))
9117 {
9118 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9119 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
9120 }
9121 }
9122
9123 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
9124 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
9125 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9126 }
9127
9128 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9129 just by the event that we get from the server.
9130 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9131 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9132 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9133 f->visible = 0;
9134 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9135 f->async_visible = 0;
9136 f->async_iconified = 0;
9137
9138 x_sync (f);
9139
9140 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9141 }
9142
9143 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9144
9145 void
9146 x_iconify_frame (f)
9147 struct frame *f;
9148 {
9149 int result;
9150 Lisp_Object type;
9151
9152 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9153 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9154 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9155
9156 if (f->async_iconified)
9157 return;
9158
9159 BLOCK_INPUT;
9160
9161 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9162
9163 type = x_icon_type (f);
9164 if (!NILP (type))
9165 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9166
9167 #ifdef USE_GTK
9168 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9169 {
9170 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9171 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9172
9173 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9174 f->iconified = 1;
9175 f->visible = 1;
9176 f->async_iconified = 1;
9177 f->async_visible = 0;
9178 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9179 return;
9180 }
9181 #endif
9182
9183 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9184
9185 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9186 {
9187 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9188 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9189 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9190 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9191 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9192 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9193 so we have to record it here. */
9194 f->iconified = 1;
9195 f->visible = 1;
9196 f->async_iconified = 1;
9197 f->async_visible = 0;
9198 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9199 return;
9200 }
9201
9202 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9203 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9204 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9205 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9206
9207 if (!result)
9208 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9209
9210 f->async_iconified = 1;
9211 f->async_visible = 0;
9212
9213
9214 BLOCK_INPUT;
9215 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9216 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9217 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9218
9219 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9220 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9221 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9222 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9223
9224 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9225 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9226
9227 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9228 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9229 {
9230 XEvent message;
9231
9232 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9233 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9234 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9235 message.xclient.format = 32;
9236 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9237
9238 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9239 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9240 False,
9241 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9242 &message))
9243 {
9244 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9245 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9246 }
9247 }
9248
9249 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9250 IconicState. */
9251 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9252
9253 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9254 {
9255 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9256 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9257 }
9258
9259 f->async_iconified = 1;
9260 f->async_visible = 0;
9261
9262 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9263 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9264 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9265 }
9266
9267 \f
9268 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9269
9270 void
9271 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9272 struct frame *f;
9273 {
9274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9275 Lisp_Object bar;
9276 struct scroll_bar *b;
9277
9278 BLOCK_INPUT;
9279
9280 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9281 commands to the X server. */
9282 if (dpyinfo->display)
9283 {
9284 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9285 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9286
9287 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9288 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9289 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9290 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9291 toolkit scroll bars. */
9292 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9293 {
9294 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9295 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9296 }
9297 #endif
9298
9299 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9300 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9301 free_frame_xic (f);
9302 #endif
9303
9304 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9305 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9306 {
9307 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9308 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9309 }
9310 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9311 we are using a toolkit. */
9312 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9313 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9314
9315 free_frame_menubar (f);
9316 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9317
9318 #ifdef USE_GTK
9319 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9320 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9321 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9322 {
9323 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9324 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9325 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9326 }
9327 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9328
9329 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9330 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9331 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9332
9333 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9334 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9335 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9336 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9337 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9338 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9339
9340 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9341 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9342 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9343 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9344 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9345 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9346 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9347 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9348 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9349 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9350 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9351 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9352 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9353 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9354 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9355
9356 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9357 free_frame_faces (f);
9358
9359 x_free_gcs (f);
9360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9361 }
9362
9363 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9364 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9365
9366 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9367 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9368
9369 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9370 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9371 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9372 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9373 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9374 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9375
9376 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9377 {
9378 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9379 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9380 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9381 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9383 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9384 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9385 }
9386
9387 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9388 }
9389
9390
9391 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9392
9393 void
9394 x_destroy_window (f)
9395 struct frame *f;
9396 {
9397 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9398
9399 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9400 commands to the X server. */
9401 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9402 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9403
9404 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9405 }
9406
9407 \f
9408 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9409
9410 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9411 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9412 that the window now has.
9413 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9414 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9415 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9416
9417 #ifndef USE_GTK
9418 void
9419 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9420 struct frame *f;
9421 long flags;
9422 int user_position;
9423 {
9424 XSizeHints size_hints;
9425
9426 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9427 Arg al[2];
9428 int ac = 0;
9429 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9430 #endif
9431
9432 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9433
9434 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9435 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9436
9437 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9438 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9439
9440 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9441 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9442 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9443 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9444 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9445 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9446 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9447 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9448 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9449 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9450
9451 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9452 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9453 size_hints.max_width
9454 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9455 size_hints.max_height
9456 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9457
9458 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9459
9460 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9461 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9462 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9463 {
9464 int base_width, base_height;
9465 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9466
9467 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9468 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9469
9470 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9471
9472 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9473 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9474 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9475 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9476 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9477
9478 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9479 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9480 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9481
9482 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9483 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9484 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9485 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9486 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9487 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9488 #else
9489 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9490 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9491 #endif
9492 }
9493
9494 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9495 if (flags)
9496 {
9497 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9498 goto no_read;
9499 }
9500 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9501
9502 {
9503 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9504 long supplied_return;
9505 int value;
9506
9507 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9508 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9509 &supplied_return);
9510 #else
9511 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9512 #endif
9513
9514 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9515 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9516 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9517 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9518 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9519 #endif
9520
9521 if (flags)
9522 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9523 else
9524 {
9525 if (value == 0)
9526 hints.flags = 0;
9527 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9528 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9529 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9530 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9531 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9532 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9533 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9534 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9535 }
9536 }
9537
9538 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9539 no_read:
9540 #endif
9541
9542 #ifdef PWinGravity
9543 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9544 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9545
9546 if (user_position)
9547 {
9548 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9549 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9550 }
9551 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9552
9553 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9554 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9555 #else
9556 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9557 #endif
9558 }
9559 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9560
9561 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9562
9563 void
9564 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9565 struct frame *f;
9566 int state;
9567 {
9568 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9569 Arg al[1];
9570
9571 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9572 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9573 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9574 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9575
9576 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9577 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9578
9579 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9580 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9581 }
9582
9583 void
9584 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9585 struct frame *f;
9586 int pixmap_id;
9587 {
9588 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9589
9590 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9591 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9592 #endif
9593
9594 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9595 {
9596 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9597 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9598 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9599 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9600 }
9601 else
9602 {
9603 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9604 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9605 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9606 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9607 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9608 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9609 best to explicitly give up. */
9610 #if 0
9611 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9612 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9613 #else
9614 return;
9615 #endif
9616 }
9617
9618
9619 #ifdef USE_GTK
9620 {
9621 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9622 return;
9623 }
9624
9625 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9626
9627 {
9628 Arg al[1];
9629 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9630 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9631 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9632 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9633 }
9634
9635 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9636
9637 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9638 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9639
9640 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9641 }
9642
9643 void
9644 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9645 struct frame *f;
9646 int icon_x, icon_y;
9647 {
9648 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9649
9650 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9651 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9652 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9653
9654 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9655 }
9656
9657 \f
9658 /***********************************************************************
9659 Fonts
9660 ***********************************************************************/
9661
9662 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9663
9664 struct font_info *
9665 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9666 FRAME_PTR f;
9667 int font_idx;
9668 {
9669 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9670 }
9671
9672
9673 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9674
9675 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9676 to be listed.
9677
9678 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9679
9680 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9681 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9682 on how many fonts to match. */
9683
9684 Lisp_Object
9685 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9686 struct frame *f;
9687 Lisp_Object pattern;
9688 int size;
9689 int maxnames;
9690 {
9691 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9692 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9693 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9694 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9695 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9696 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9697 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9698
9699 if (size < 0)
9700 {
9701 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9702 size = 0;
9703 }
9704
9705 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9706 if (NILP (patterns))
9707 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9708
9709 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9710 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9711 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9712
9713 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9714 {
9715 int num_fonts;
9716 char **names = NULL;
9717
9718 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9719 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9720 The cache is an alist of the form:
9721 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9722 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9723 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9724 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9725 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9726 if (!NILP (list))
9727 {
9728 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9729 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9730 goto label_cached;
9731 }
9732
9733 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9734
9735 BLOCK_INPUT;
9736 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9737
9738 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9739 {
9740 XFontStruct *font;
9741 unsigned long value;
9742
9743 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9744 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9745 {
9746 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9747 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9748 font = NULL;
9749 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9750 }
9751
9752 if (font
9753 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9754 {
9755 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9756 int len = strlen (name);
9757 char *tmp;
9758
9759 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9760 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9761 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9762 if (len == 0)
9763 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9764 else
9765 {
9766 num_fonts = 1;
9767 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9768 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9769 simple var. */
9770 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9771 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9772 XFree (name);
9773 }
9774 }
9775 else
9776 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9777
9778 if (font)
9779 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9780 }
9781
9782 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9783 {
9784 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9785 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9786 if (maxnames < 0)
9787 {
9788 int limit;
9789
9790 for (limit = 500;;)
9791 {
9792 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9793 if (num_fonts == limit)
9794 {
9795 BLOCK_INPUT;
9796 XFreeFontNames (names);
9797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9798 limit *= 2;
9799 }
9800 else
9801 break;
9802 }
9803 }
9804 else
9805 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9806 &num_fonts);
9807
9808 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9809 {
9810 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9811 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9812 names = NULL;
9813 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9814 }
9815 }
9816
9817 x_uncatch_errors ();
9818 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9819
9820 if (names)
9821 {
9822 int i;
9823
9824 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9825 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9826 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9827 {
9828 int width = 0;
9829 char *p = names[i];
9830 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9831
9832 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9833 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9834 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9835 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9836 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9837 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9838 while (*p)
9839 if (*p++ == '-')
9840 {
9841 dashes++;
9842 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9843 width = atoi (p);
9844 else if (dashes == 9)
9845 resx = atoi (p);
9846 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9847 average_width = atoi (p);
9848 }
9849
9850 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9851 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9852 {
9853 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9854 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9855 {
9856 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9857 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9858 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9859 >= 0))
9860 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9861 width of this font. */
9862 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9863 else
9864 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9865 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9866 }
9867 }
9868 }
9869
9870 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9871 {
9872 BLOCK_INPUT;
9873 XFreeFontNames (names);
9874 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9875 }
9876 }
9877
9878 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9879 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9880 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9881
9882 label_cached:
9883 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9884
9885 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9886 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9887 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9888 {
9889 int found_size;
9890
9891 tem = XCAR (list);
9892
9893 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9894 continue;
9895 if (!size)
9896 {
9897 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9898 continue;
9899 }
9900
9901 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9902 {
9903 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9904 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9905 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9906
9907 BLOCK_INPUT;
9908 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9909 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9910 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9911 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9912 {
9913 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9914 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9915 thisinfo = NULL;
9916 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9917 }
9918 x_uncatch_errors ();
9919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9920
9921 if (thisinfo)
9922 {
9923 XSETCDR (tem,
9924 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9925 ? make_number (0)
9926 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9927 BLOCK_INPUT;
9928 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9929 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9930 }
9931 else
9932 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9933 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9934 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9935 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9936 }
9937
9938 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9939 if (found_size == size)
9940 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9941 else if (found_size > 0)
9942 {
9943 if (NILP (second_best))
9944 second_best = tem;
9945 else if (found_size < size)
9946 {
9947 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9948 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9949 second_best = tem;
9950 }
9951 else
9952 {
9953 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9954 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9955 second_best = tem;
9956 }
9957 }
9958 }
9959 if (!NILP (newlist))
9960 break;
9961 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9962 {
9963 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9964 break;
9965 }
9966 }
9967
9968 return newlist;
9969 }
9970
9971
9972 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9973
9974 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9975 font table. */
9976
9977 static void
9978 x_check_font (f, font)
9979 struct frame *f;
9980 XFontStruct *font;
9981 {
9982 int i;
9983 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9984
9985 xassert (font != NULL);
9986
9987 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9988 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9989 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9990 break;
9991
9992 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9993 }
9994
9995 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9996
9997 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9998 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9999 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10000 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10001 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10002
10003 static INLINE void
10004 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10005 XFontStruct *font;
10006 int *w, *h;
10007 {
10008 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10009 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10010
10011 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10012 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10013 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10014 if (*w <= 0)
10015 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10016 }
10017
10018
10019 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10020 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10021 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10022 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10023 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10024
10025 static int
10026 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10027 struct frame *f;
10028 {
10029 int i;
10030 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10031 XFontStruct *font;
10032 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10033 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10034
10035 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10036 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10037
10038 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10039 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10040 {
10041 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10042 int w, h;
10043
10044 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10045 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
10046 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10047
10048 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10049 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10050 }
10051
10052 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10053 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10054
10055 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10056 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10057 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10058 }
10059
10060
10061 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10062 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10063 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10064 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10065
10066 struct font_info *
10067 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10068 struct frame *f;
10069 register char *fontname;
10070 int size;
10071 {
10072 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10073 Lisp_Object font_names;
10074
10075 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10076 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10077 we already have by comparing names. */
10078 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10079
10080 if (!NILP (font_names))
10081 {
10082 Lisp_Object tail;
10083 int i;
10084
10085 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10086 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10087 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10088 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10089 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
10090 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10091 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
10092 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10093 }
10094
10095 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10096 {
10097 char *full_name;
10098 XFontStruct *font;
10099 struct font_info *fontp;
10100 unsigned long value;
10101 int i;
10102
10103 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10104 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10105 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10106 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10107 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10108 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10109 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10110
10111 BLOCK_INPUT;
10112 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10113 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10114 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10115 {
10116 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10117 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10118 font = NULL;
10119 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10120 }
10121 x_uncatch_errors ();
10122 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10123 if (!font)
10124 return NULL;
10125
10126 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10127 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10128 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10129 break;
10130
10131 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10132 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10133 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10134 {
10135 int sz;
10136 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10137 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10138 dpyinfo->font_table
10139 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10140 }
10141
10142 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10143 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10144 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10145
10146 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10147 BLOCK_INPUT;
10148 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10149 fontp->font = font;
10150 fontp->font_idx = i;
10151 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10152 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10153
10154 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10155 {
10156 /* Fixed width font. */
10157 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10158 }
10159 else
10160 {
10161 XChar2b char2b;
10162 XCharStruct *pcm;
10163
10164 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10165 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10166 if (pcm)
10167 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10168 else
10169 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10170
10171 fontp->average_width
10172 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10173 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10174 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10175 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10176 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10177 {
10178 if (pcm)
10179 {
10180 int width = pcm->width;
10181 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10182 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10183 width += pcm->width;
10184 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10185 }
10186 else
10187 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10188 }
10189 }
10190
10191 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10192 full_name = 0;
10193 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10194 {
10195 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10196 char *p = name;
10197 int dashes = 0;
10198
10199 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10200 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10201 so don't use it.
10202 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10203 stored in them. */
10204 while (*p)
10205 {
10206 if (*p == '-')
10207 dashes++;
10208 p++;
10209 }
10210
10211 if (dashes >= 13)
10212 {
10213 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10214 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10215 }
10216
10217 XFree (name);
10218 }
10219
10220 if (full_name != 0)
10221 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10222 else
10223 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10224
10225 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10226 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10227
10228 if (NILP (font_names))
10229 {
10230 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10231 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10232 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10233 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10234 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10235 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10236 Qnil);
10237
10238 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10239 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10240 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10241 make_number (fontp->size)),
10242 Qnil)),
10243 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10244 if (full_name)
10245 {
10246 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10247 Qnil);
10248 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10249 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10250 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10251 make_number (fontp->size)),
10252 Qnil)),
10253 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10254 }
10255 }
10256
10257 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10258 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10259 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10260 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10261 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10262 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10263 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10264 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10265 fontp->encoding[1]
10266 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10267 /* 1-byte font */
10268 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10269 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10270 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10271 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10272 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10273 /* 2-byte font */
10274 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10275 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10276 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10277 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10278 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10279 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10280 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10281 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10282 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10283 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10284 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10285 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10286 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10287
10288 fontp->baseline_offset
10289 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10290 ? (long) value : 0);
10291 fontp->relative_compose
10292 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10293 ? (long) value : 0);
10294 fontp->default_ascent
10295 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10296 ? (long) value : 0);
10297
10298 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10299 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10300 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10301 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10302 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10303 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10304 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10305 return fontp;
10306 }
10307 }
10308
10309
10310 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10311 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10312
10313 struct font_info *
10314 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10315 struct frame *f;
10316 register char *fontname;
10317 {
10318 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10319 int i;
10320
10321 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10322 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10323 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10324 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10325 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10326 return NULL;
10327 }
10328
10329
10330 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10331 `encoder' of the structure. */
10332
10333 void
10334 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10335 struct font_info *fontp;
10336 {
10337 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10338
10339 elt = Qnil;
10340 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10341 {
10342 elt = XCAR (list);
10343 if (CONSP (elt)
10344 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10345 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10346 >= 0)
10347 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10348 >= 0)))
10349 break;
10350 }
10351
10352 if (! NILP (list))
10353 {
10354 struct ccl_program *ccl
10355 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10356
10357 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10358 xfree (ccl);
10359 else
10360 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10361 }
10362 }
10363
10364
10365 \f
10366 /***********************************************************************
10367 Initialization
10368 ***********************************************************************/
10369
10370 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10371 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10372 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10373 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10374
10375 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10376 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10377 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10378
10379 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10380 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10381 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10382 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10383 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10384 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10385 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10386 };
10387
10388 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10389
10390 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10391
10392 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10393
10394 static int x_initialized;
10395
10396 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10397 static int x_session_initialized;
10398 #endif
10399
10400 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10401 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10402 the screen number from the server number. */
10403 static int
10404 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10405 const char *name1, *name2;
10406 {
10407 int seen_colon = 0;
10408 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10409 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10410 int length_until_period = 0;
10411
10412 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10413 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10414 length_until_period++;
10415
10416 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10417 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10418 name1 += 4;
10419 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10420 name2 += 4;
10421 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10422 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10423 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10424 name1 += system_name_length;
10425 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10426 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10427 name2 += system_name_length;
10428 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10429 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10430 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10431 name1 += length_until_period;
10432 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10433 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10434 name2 += length_until_period;
10435
10436 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10437 {
10438 if (*name1 == ':')
10439 seen_colon++;
10440 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10441 return 1;
10442 }
10443 return (seen_colon
10444 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10445 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10446 }
10447 #endif
10448
10449 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10450 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10451 to 5. */
10452 static void
10453 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10454 unsigned long mask;
10455 int *bits;
10456 int *offset;
10457 {
10458 int nr = 0;
10459 int off = 0;
10460
10461 while (!(mask & 1))
10462 {
10463 off++;
10464 mask >>= 1;
10465 }
10466
10467 while (mask & 1)
10468 {
10469 nr++;
10470 mask >>= 1;
10471 }
10472
10473 *offset = off;
10474 *bits = nr;
10475 }
10476
10477 int
10478 x_display_ok (display)
10479 const char * display;
10480 {
10481 int dpy_ok = 1;
10482 Display *dpy;
10483
10484 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10485 if (dpy)
10486 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10487 else
10488 dpy_ok = 0;
10489 return dpy_ok;
10490 }
10491
10492 struct x_display_info *
10493 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10494 Lisp_Object display_name;
10495 char *xrm_option;
10496 char *resource_name;
10497 {
10498 int connection;
10499 Display *dpy;
10500 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10501 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10502
10503 BLOCK_INPUT;
10504
10505 if (!x_initialized)
10506 {
10507 x_initialize ();
10508 ++x_initialized;
10509 }
10510
10511 #ifdef USE_GTK
10512 {
10513 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10514 int argc;
10515 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10516 char **argv2 = argv;
10517 GdkAtom atom;
10518
10519 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10520 {
10521 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10522 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10523 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10524 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10525 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10526 }
10527 else
10528 {
10529 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10530 argv[argc] = 0;
10531
10532 argc = 0;
10533 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10534
10535 if (! NILP (display_name))
10536 {
10537 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10538 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10539 }
10540
10541 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10542 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10543
10544 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10545 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10546 #endif
10547
10548 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10549
10550 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10551 fixup_locale ();
10552 xg_initialize ();
10553
10554 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10555
10556 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10557 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10558
10559 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10560 {
10561 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10562 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10563
10564 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10565 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10566
10567 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10568 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10569 }
10570
10571 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10572 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10573 }
10574 }
10575 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10576 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10577 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10578 errors with X11R5:
10579 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10580 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10581 So let's not use it until R6. */
10582 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10583 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10584 #endif
10585
10586 {
10587 int argc = 0;
10588 char *argv[3];
10589
10590 argv[0] = "";
10591 argc = 1;
10592 if (xrm_option)
10593 {
10594 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10595 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10596 }
10597 turn_on_atimers (0);
10598 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10599 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10600 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10601 &argc, argv);
10602 turn_on_atimers (1);
10603
10604 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10605 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10606 fixup_locale ();
10607 #endif
10608 }
10609
10610 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10611 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10612 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10613 #endif
10614 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10615 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10616 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10617
10618 /* Detect failure. */
10619 if (dpy == 0)
10620 {
10621 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10622 return 0;
10623 }
10624
10625 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10626
10627 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10628 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10629
10630 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10631 {
10632 struct x_display_info *share;
10633 Lisp_Object tail;
10634
10635 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10636 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10637 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10638 SDATA (display_name)))
10639 break;
10640 if (share)
10641 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10642 else
10643 {
10644 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10645 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10646 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10647 {
10648 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10650 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10651 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10652 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10653 BLOCK_INPUT;
10654 }
10655
10656 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10657 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10658 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10659 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10660 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10661 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10662 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10663 }
10664 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10665 }
10666 #endif
10667
10668 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10669 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10670 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10671
10672 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10673 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10674 x_display_name_list);
10675 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10676
10677 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10678
10679 #if 0
10680 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10681 #endif /* ! 0 */
10682
10683 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10684 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10685 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10686 + 2);
10687 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10688 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10689
10690 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10691 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10692
10693 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10694 #ifdef USE_GTK
10695 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10696 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10697 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10698
10699 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10700 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10701
10702 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10703 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10704 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10705 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10706 #else
10707 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10708 #endif
10709 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10710 all versions. */
10711 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10712
10713 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10714 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10715 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10716 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10717 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10718 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10719 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10720 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10721 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10722 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10723 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10724 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10725 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10726 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10727 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10728 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10729 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10730 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10731 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10732 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10733 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10734 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10735 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10736 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10737 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10738 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10739 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10740 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10741 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10742 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10743 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10744 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10745 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10746
10747 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10748 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10749 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10750
10751 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10752 {
10753 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10754 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10755 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10756 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10757 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10758 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10759 }
10760
10761 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10762 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10763 {
10764 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10765 {
10766 Lisp_Object value;
10767 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10768 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10769 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10770 Qnil, Qnil);
10771 if (STRINGP (value)
10772 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10773 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10774 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10775 }
10776 }
10777 else
10778 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10779 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10780
10781 {
10782 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10783 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10784 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10785 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10786 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10787 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10788 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10789 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10790 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10791 }
10792
10793 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10794 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10795 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10796 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10797 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10798 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10799 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10800 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10801 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10802 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10803 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10804 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10805 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10806 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10807 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10808 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10809 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10810 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10811 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10812 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10813 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10814 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10815 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10816 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10817 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10818 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10819 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10820 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10821 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10822 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10823 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10824 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10825 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10826 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10827 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10828 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10829 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10830 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10831 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10832 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10833 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10834 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10835 /* For properties of font. */
10836 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10837 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10838 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10839 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10840 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10841 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10842 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10843 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10844 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10845 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10846
10847 /* Ghostscript support. */
10848 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10849 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10850
10851 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10852 False);
10853
10854 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10855
10856 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10857 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10858 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10859 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10860
10861 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10862 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10863 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10864
10865 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10866 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10867
10868 {
10869 char null_bits[1];
10870
10871 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10872
10873 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10874 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10875 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10876 1);
10877 }
10878
10879 {
10880 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10881 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10882 dpyinfo->gray
10883 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10884 gray_bitmap_bits,
10885 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10886 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10887 }
10888
10889 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10890 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10891 #endif
10892
10893 #ifdef subprocesses
10894 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10895 if (connection != 0)
10896 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10897 #endif
10898
10899 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10900 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10901 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10902 /* stdin is a socket here */
10903 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10904 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10905 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10906 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10907 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10908 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10909
10910 #ifdef SIGIO
10911 if (interrupt_input)
10912 init_sigio (connection);
10913 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10914
10915 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10916 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10917 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10918 so that Xt does not crash. */
10919 {
10920 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10921 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10922 Font font;
10923
10924 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10925 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10926 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10927 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10928 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10929 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10930 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10931 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10932 abort ();
10933 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10934 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10935 x_uncatch_errors ();
10936 }
10937 #endif
10938 #endif
10939
10940 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10941 for debugging X code. */
10942 {
10943 Lisp_Object value;
10944 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10945 build_string ("synchronous"),
10946 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10947 Qnil, Qnil);
10948 if (STRINGP (value)
10949 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10950 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10951 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10952 }
10953
10954 {
10955 Lisp_Object value;
10956 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10957 build_string ("useXIM"),
10958 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10959 Qnil, Qnil);
10960 #ifdef USE_XIM
10961 if (STRINGP (value)
10962 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10963 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10964 use_xim = 0;
10965 #else
10966 if (STRINGP (value)
10967 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10968 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10969 use_xim = 1;
10970 #endif
10971 }
10972
10973 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10974 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10975 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10976 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10977 #endif
10978
10979 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10980
10981 return dpyinfo;
10982 }
10983 \f
10984 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10985 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10986
10987 void
10988 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10990 {
10991 int i;
10992
10993 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10994
10995 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10996 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10997 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10998 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10999 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
11000 else
11001 {
11002 Lisp_Object tail;
11003
11004 tail = x_display_name_list;
11005 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
11006 {
11007 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11008 {
11009 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
11010 break;
11011 }
11012 tail = XCDR (tail);
11013 }
11014 }
11015
11016 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11017 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11018
11019 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11020 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11021 else
11022 {
11023 struct x_display_info *tail;
11024
11025 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11026 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11027 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11028 }
11029
11030 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11031 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11032 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11033 #endif
11034 #endif
11035 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11036 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
11037 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
11038 #endif
11039 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11040 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11041 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11042 #endif
11043
11044 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11045 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11046 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11047 {
11048 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
11049 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
11050 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
11051 }
11052
11053 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
11054 {
11055 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
11056 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
11057 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
11058 }
11059 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
11060 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11061 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
11062 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11063 xfree (dpyinfo);
11064 }
11065
11066 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11067
11068 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11069 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11070 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11071 that slows us down. */
11072
11073 static void
11074 x_process_timeouts (timer)
11075 struct atimer *timer;
11076 {
11077 BLOCK_INPUT;
11078 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11079 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11080 {
11081 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11082 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11083 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11084 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11085 }
11086 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11087 }
11088
11089 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11090 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11091 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11092 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11093 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11094 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11095 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11096
11097 void
11098 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11099 {
11100 BLOCK_INPUT;
11101 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11102 {
11103 EMACS_TIME interval;
11104
11105 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
11106 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11107 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11108 }
11109 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11110 }
11111
11112 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11113
11114 \f
11115 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11116
11117 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11118
11119 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11120 {
11121 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11122 x_produce_glyphs,
11123 x_write_glyphs,
11124 x_insert_glyphs,
11125 x_clear_end_of_line,
11126 x_scroll_run,
11127 x_after_update_window_line,
11128 x_update_window_begin,
11129 x_update_window_end,
11130 x_cursor_to,
11131 x_flush,
11132 #ifdef XFlush
11133 x_flush,
11134 #else
11135 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11136 #endif
11137 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11138 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11139 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11140 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11141 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11142 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11143 x_per_char_metric,
11144 x_encode_char,
11145 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11146 x_draw_glyph_string,
11147 x_define_frame_cursor,
11148 x_clear_frame_area,
11149 x_draw_window_cursor,
11150 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11151 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11152 };
11153
11154 void
11155 x_initialize ()
11156 {
11157 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11158
11159 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11160 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11161 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11162 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11163 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11164 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11165 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11166 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11167 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11168 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11169 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11170 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11171 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11172 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11173 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11174 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11175 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11176 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11177 fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11178
11179 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
11180 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11181 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
11182 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
11183 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
11184 off the bottom */
11185 baud_rate = 19200;
11186
11187 x_noop_count = 0;
11188 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11189 any_help_event_p = 0;
11190 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11191 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11192 x_session_initialized = 0;
11193 #endif
11194
11195 #ifdef USE_GTK
11196 current_count = -1;
11197 #endif
11198
11199 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11200 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
11201
11202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11203 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11204
11205 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11206
11207 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11208 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11209 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11210 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11211 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11212 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11213 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11214
11215 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11216 #endif
11217
11218 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11219 #ifndef USE_GTK
11220 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11221 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11222 #endif
11223 #endif
11224
11225 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11226 original error handler. */
11227 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11228 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11229
11230 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11231 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11232 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11233 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11234
11235 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11236 }
11237
11238
11239 void
11240 syms_of_xterm ()
11241 {
11242 x_error_message = NULL;
11243
11244 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
11245 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
11246
11247 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
11248 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
11249
11250 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
11251 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
11252
11253 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
11254 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
11255 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
11256 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
11257
11258 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
11259 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11260
11261 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11262 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
11263 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11264 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11265 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11266 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
11267 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
11268
11269 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11270 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
11271 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11272 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11273 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11274 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11275 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
11276
11277 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11278 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11279 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11280 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11281 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11282 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11283 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11284 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11285 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
11286
11287 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11288 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
11289 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
11290 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
11291 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11292 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11293 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
11294 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11295 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
11296 #elif USE_GTK
11297 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
11298 #else
11299 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
11300 #endif
11301 #else
11302 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11303 #endif
11304
11305 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
11306 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
11307
11308 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
11309 Qalt = intern ("alt");
11310 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11311 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
11312 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11313 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
11314 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11315 Qsuper = intern ("super");
11316 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11317
11318 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
11319 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11320 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11321 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11322 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11323 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11324
11325 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
11326 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11327 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11328 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11329 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11330 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11331
11332 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
11333 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11334 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11335 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11336 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11337 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11338
11339 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
11340 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11341 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11342 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11343 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11344 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11345
11346 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
11347 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11348 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
11349 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11350 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11351 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
11352 }
11353
11354 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
11355
11356 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
11357 (do not change this comment) */